Remove ptid_equal
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "continuations.h"
63 #include "stack.h"
64 #include "skip.h"
65 #include "ax-gdb.h"
66 #include "dummy-frame.h"
67 #include "interps.h"
68 #include "format.h"
69 #include "thread-fsm.h"
70 #include "tid-parse.h"
71
72 /* readline include files */
73 #include "readline/readline.h"
74 #include "readline/history.h"
75
76 /* readline defines this. */
77 #undef savestring
78
79 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
80 #include "extension.h"
81 #include <algorithm>
82 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
83 #include "common/array-view.h"
84 #include "common/gdb_optional.h"
85
86 /* Enums for exception-handling support. */
87 enum exception_event_kind
88 {
89 EX_EVENT_THROW,
90 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
91 EX_EVENT_CATCH
92 };
93
94 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
95
96 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
97 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
98
99 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
100
101 static void
102 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
103 struct linespec_result *canonical,
104 enum bptype type_wanted);
105
106 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
107 struct linespec_result *,
108 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
109 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
110 enum bptype,
111 enum bpdisp, int, int,
112 int,
113 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
114 int, int, int, unsigned);
115
116 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
117 (struct breakpoint *b, const struct event_location *location,
118 struct program_space *search_pspace);
119
120 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
121 (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
122
123 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
124
125 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
126 enum bptype,
127 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
128 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
129 const struct symtab_and_line *);
130
131 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
132 static. */
133 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
134 struct symtab_and_line,
135 enum bptype,
136 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
137
138 static struct breakpoint *
139 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
140 enum bptype type,
141 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
142 int loc_enabled);
143
144 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
145
146 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
147 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
148 enum bptype bptype);
149
150 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
151 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
152 struct obj_section *, int);
153
154 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
155 struct bp_location *loc2);
156
157 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
158 const struct address_space *aspace,
159 CORE_ADDR addr);
160
161 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
162 const address_space *,
163 CORE_ADDR, int);
164
165 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
166 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
167
168 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
169
170 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
171
172 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
173
174 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
175 enum bptype type,
176 int *other_type_used);
177
178 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
179 int count);
180
181 static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
182 static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
183 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
184
185 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
186
187 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
188 insert locations now. */
189 enum ugll_insert_mode
190 {
191 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
192 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
193 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
194 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
195 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
196 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
197 returns true on them.
198
199 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
200 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
201 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
202 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
203 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
204 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
205 the inferior. */
206 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
207
208 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
209 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
210 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
211
212 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
213 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
214 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
215 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
216 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
217 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
218 as no thread is running yet. */
219 UGLL_INSERT
220 };
221
222 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
223
224 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
225
226 static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
227
228 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
229
230 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
231
232 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
233
234 static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
235
236 static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
237
238 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
239 otherwise. */
240
241 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
242
243 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
244 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
245 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
246 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
247
248 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
249 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
250
251 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
252 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
253
254 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
255 breakpoints. */
256 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
257
258 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
259 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
260
261 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
262 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
263
264 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
265 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
266 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
267 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
268 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
269 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
270
271 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
272 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
273 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
274 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
275 dprintf_style_gdb,
276 dprintf_style_call,
277 dprintf_style_agent,
278 NULL
279 };
280 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
281
282 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
283 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
284 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
285 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
286
287 static char *dprintf_function;
288
289 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
290 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
291 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
292 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
293 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
294 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
295 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
296
297 static char *dprintf_channel;
298
299 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
300 has disconnected. */
301 static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
302
303 struct command_line *
304 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
305 {
306 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
307 }
308
309 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
310 current breakpoint. */
311
312 static int breakpoint_proceeded;
313
314 const char *
315 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
316 {
317 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
318 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
319 a breakpoint. */
320 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
321
322 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
323 }
324
325 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
326 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
327 if such is available. */
328 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
329
330 static void
331 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
332 struct cmd_list_element *c,
333 const char *value)
334 {
335 fprintf_filtered (file,
336 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
337 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
338 value);
339 }
340
341 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
342 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
343 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
344 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
345 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
346 static void
347 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
348 struct cmd_list_element *c,
349 const char *value)
350 {
351 fprintf_filtered (file,
352 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
353 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
354 value);
355 }
356
357 /* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
358 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
359 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
360 use hardware breakpoints. */
361 static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
362 static void
363 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
364 struct cmd_list_element *c,
365 const char *value)
366 {
367 fprintf_filtered (file,
368 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
369 value);
370 }
371
372 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
373 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
374 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
375 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
376 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
377 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
378 processing user input. */
379 static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
380
381 static void
382 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
383 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
384 {
385 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
386 value);
387 }
388
389 /* See breakpoint.h. */
390
391 int
392 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
393 {
394 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
395 {
396 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
397 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
398 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
399 return 1;
400 }
401 else if (target_has_execution)
402 {
403 struct thread_info *tp;
404
405 if (always_inserted_mode)
406 {
407 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
408 are stopped. */
409 return 1;
410 }
411
412 if (threads_are_executing ())
413 return 1;
414
415 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
416 stopped, we still have events to process. */
417 ALL_NON_EXITED_THREADS (tp)
418 if (tp->resumed
419 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
420 return 1;
421 }
422 return 0;
423 }
424
425 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
426
427 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
428 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
429 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
430 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
431 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
432 condition_evaluation_auto,
433 condition_evaluation_host,
434 condition_evaluation_target,
435 NULL
436 };
437
438 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
439 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
440
441 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
442 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
443 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
444
445 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
446 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
447 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
448 evaluation mode. */
449
450 static const char *
451 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
452 {
453 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
454 {
455 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
456 return condition_evaluation_target;
457 else
458 return condition_evaluation_host;
459 }
460 else
461 return mode;
462 }
463
464 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
465
466 static const char *
467 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
468 {
469 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
470 }
471
472 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
473 otherwise. */
474
475 static int
476 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
477 {
478 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
479
480 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
481 }
482
483 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
484 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
485
486 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
487 static int overlay_events_enabled;
488
489 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
490 int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
491
492 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
493 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
494 current breakpoint. */
495
496 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
497
498 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
499 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
500 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
501 B = TMP)
502
503 /* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
504 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
505 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
506
507 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
508 for (BP_TMP = bp_locations; \
509 BP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count && (B = *BP_TMP);\
510 BP_TMP++)
511
512 /* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
513 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
514 to where the loop should start from.
515 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
516 appropriate location to start with. */
517
518 #define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
519 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
520 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
521 BP_LOCP_START \
522 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_locations + bp_locations_count \
523 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
524 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
525
526 /* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
527
528 #define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
529 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
530 if (is_tracepoint (B))
531
532 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
533
534 struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
535
536 /* Array is sorted by bp_locations_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
537
538 static struct bp_location **bp_locations;
539
540 /* Number of elements of BP_LOCATIONS. */
541
542 static unsigned bp_locations_count;
543
544 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
545 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
546 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
547 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
548 an address you need to read. */
549
550 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
551
552 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
553 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
554 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
555 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
556 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
557
558 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
559
560 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
561 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
562 reported by a target. */
563 VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
564
565 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
566
567 static int breakpoint_count;
568
569 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
570 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
571 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
572 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
573 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
574
575 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
576
577 static int tracepoint_count;
578
579 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
580 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
581 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
582
583 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
584
585 struct breakpoint *
586 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
587 void *user_data)
588 {
589 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
590
591 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
592 {
593 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
594 break;
595 }
596
597 return b;
598 }
599
600 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
601 static int
602 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
603 {
604 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
605 }
606
607 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
608
609 static void
610 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
611 {
612 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
613 breakpoint_count = num;
614 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
615 }
616
617 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
618 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
619 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
620
621 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
622 breakpoint made. */
623
624 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
625 {
626 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
627 }
628
629 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
630 breakpoint made. */
631
632 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
633 {
634 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
635 }
636
637 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
638
639 void
640 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
641 {
642 struct breakpoint *b;
643
644 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
645 b->hit_count = 0;
646 }
647
648 \f
649 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
650 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
651
652 struct breakpoint *
653 get_breakpoint (int num)
654 {
655 struct breakpoint *b;
656
657 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
658 if (b->number == num)
659 return b;
660
661 return NULL;
662 }
663
664 \f
665
666 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
667 evaluating conditions on its side. */
668
669 static void
670 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
671 {
672 struct bp_location *loc;
673
674 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
675 evaluating conditions and if the user has
676 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
677 side. */
678 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
679 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
680 return;
681
682 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
683 return;
684
685 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
686 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
687 }
688
689 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
690 evaluating conditions on its side. */
691
692 static void
693 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
694 {
695 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
696 evaluating conditions and if the user has
697 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
698 side. */
699 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
700 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
701
702 return;
703
704 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
705 return;
706
707 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
708 }
709
710 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
711 condition_evaluation_mode. */
712
713 static void
714 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
715 struct cmd_list_element *c)
716 {
717 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
718
719 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
720 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
721 {
722 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
723 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
724 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
725 return;
726 }
727
728 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
729 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
730
731 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
732 settings was "auto". */
733 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
734
735 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
736 if (new_mode != old_mode)
737 {
738 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
739 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
740 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
741
742 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
743 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
744 */
745
746 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
747 {
748 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
749 target. */
750 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
751 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
752 }
753 else
754 {
755 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
756 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
757 target knows about. */
758 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
759 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
760 loc->needs_update = 1;
761 }
762
763 /* Do the update. */
764 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
765 }
766
767 return;
768 }
769
770 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
771 what "auto" is translating to. */
772
773 static void
774 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
775 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
776 {
777 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
778 fprintf_filtered (file,
779 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
780 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
781 value,
782 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
783 else
784 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
785 value);
786 }
787
788 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
789 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
790 the more general bp_locations_compare function. */
791
792 static int
793 bp_locations_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
794 {
795 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
796 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
797
798 if (a->address == b->address)
799 return 0;
800 else
801 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
802 }
803
804 /* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
805 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
806 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
807 return NULL. */
808
809 static struct bp_location **
810 get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
811 {
812 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
813 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
814 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
815
816 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
817 dummy_loc.address = address;
818
819 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
820 locp_found = ((struct bp_location **)
821 bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_locations, bp_locations_count,
822 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
823 bp_locations_compare_addrs));
824
825 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
826 if (locp_found == NULL)
827 return NULL;
828
829 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
830 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
831 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_locations
832 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
833 locp_found--;
834
835 return locp_found;
836 }
837
838 void
839 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
840 int from_tty)
841 {
842 xfree (b->cond_string);
843 b->cond_string = NULL;
844
845 if (is_watchpoint (b))
846 {
847 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
848
849 w->cond_exp.reset ();
850 }
851 else
852 {
853 struct bp_location *loc;
854
855 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
856 {
857 loc->cond.reset ();
858
859 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
860 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
861 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
862 }
863 }
864
865 if (*exp == 0)
866 {
867 if (from_tty)
868 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
869 }
870 else
871 {
872 const char *arg = exp;
873
874 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
875 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
876 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
877 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
878
879 if (is_watchpoint (b))
880 {
881 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
882
883 innermost_block.reset ();
884 arg = exp;
885 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
886 if (*arg)
887 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
888 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
889 }
890 else
891 {
892 struct bp_location *loc;
893
894 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
895 {
896 arg = exp;
897 loc->cond =
898 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
899 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
900 if (*arg)
901 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
902 }
903 }
904 }
905 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
906
907 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
908 }
909
910 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
911
912 static void
913 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
914 completion_tracker &tracker,
915 const char *text, const char *word)
916 {
917 const char *space;
918
919 text = skip_spaces (text);
920 space = skip_to_space (text);
921 if (*space == '\0')
922 {
923 int len;
924 struct breakpoint *b;
925
926 if (text[0] == '$')
927 {
928 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
929 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
930 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
931 return;
932 }
933
934 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
935 len = strlen (text);
936
937 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
938 {
939 char number[50];
940
941 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
942
943 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
944 {
945 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> copy (xstrdup (number));
946 tracker.add_completion (std::move (copy));
947 }
948 }
949
950 return;
951 }
952
953 /* We're completing the expression part. */
954 text = skip_spaces (space);
955 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
956 }
957
958 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
959
960 static void
961 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
962 {
963 struct breakpoint *b;
964 const char *p;
965 int bnum;
966
967 if (arg == 0)
968 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
969
970 p = arg;
971 bnum = get_number (&p);
972 if (bnum == 0)
973 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
974
975 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
976 if (b->number == bnum)
977 {
978 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
979 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
980 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
981 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
982 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
983
984 if (extlang != NULL)
985 {
986 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
987 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
988 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
989 }
990 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
991
992 if (is_breakpoint (b))
993 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
994
995 return;
996 }
997
998 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
999 }
1000
1001 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1002 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1003 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1004
1005 static void
1006 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1007 {
1008 struct command_line *c;
1009
1010 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1011 {
1012 int i;
1013
1014 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1015 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1016 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1017
1018 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
1019 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
1020
1021 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1022 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1023 command directly. */
1024 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1025 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1026
1027 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1028 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1029 }
1030 }
1031
1032 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1033 {
1034 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1035 };
1036
1037 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1038
1039 static bool
1040 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1041 {
1042 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1043 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1044 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1045 }
1046
1047 static bool
1048 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1049 {
1050 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1051 }
1052
1053 int
1054 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1055 {
1056 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1057 }
1058
1059 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1060 TYPE. */
1061
1062 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1063 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1064 {
1065 breakpoint *b;
1066
1067 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1068 b = new tracepoint ();
1069 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1070 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1071 else
1072 b = new breakpoint ();
1073
1074 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1075 }
1076
1077 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1078 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1079 found. */
1080
1081 static void
1082 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1083 struct command_line *commands)
1084 {
1085 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1086 {
1087 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1088 struct command_line *c;
1089 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1090
1091 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1092 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1093 ones might not. */
1094 t->step_count = 0;
1095
1096 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1097 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1098 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1099 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1100 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1101 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1102 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1103 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1104 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1105 tracepoint's context. */
1106 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1107 {
1108 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1109 {
1110 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1111 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1112 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1113 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1114 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1115 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1116
1117 if (while_stepping)
1118 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1119 "can be used only once"));
1120 else
1121 while_stepping = c;
1122 }
1123
1124 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1125 }
1126 if (while_stepping)
1127 {
1128 struct command_line *c2;
1129
1130 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
1131 c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
1132 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1133 {
1134 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1135 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1136 }
1137 }
1138 }
1139 else
1140 {
1141 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1142 }
1143 }
1144
1145 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1146 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1147
1148 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
1149 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1150 {
1151 struct breakpoint *b;
1152 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1153 struct bp_location *loc;
1154
1155 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1156 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1157 {
1158 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1159 if (loc->address == addr)
1160 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1161 }
1162
1163 return found;
1164 }
1165
1166 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1167 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1168
1169 void
1170 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1171 counted_command_line &&commands)
1172 {
1173 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1174
1175 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1176 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1177 }
1178
1179 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1180 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1181 commands. */
1182
1183 void
1184 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1185 {
1186 int old_silent = b->silent;
1187
1188 b->silent = silent;
1189 if (old_silent != silent)
1190 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1191 }
1192
1193 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1194 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1195
1196 void
1197 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1198 {
1199 int old_thread = b->thread;
1200
1201 b->thread = thread;
1202 if (old_thread != thread)
1203 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1204 }
1205
1206 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1207 breakpoint work for any task. */
1208
1209 void
1210 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1211 {
1212 int old_task = b->task;
1213
1214 b->task = task;
1215 if (old_task != task)
1216 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1217 }
1218
1219 static void
1220 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1221 struct command_line *control)
1222 {
1223 counted_command_line cmd;
1224
1225 std::string new_arg;
1226
1227 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1228 {
1229 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1230 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1231 breakpoint_count);
1232 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1233 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1234 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1235 }
1236
1237 map_breakpoint_numbers
1238 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1239 {
1240 if (cmd == NULL)
1241 {
1242 if (control != NULL)
1243 cmd = control->body_list_0;
1244 else
1245 {
1246 std::string str
1247 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1248 "%s, one per line."),
1249 arg);
1250
1251 auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
1252 {
1253 validate_actionline (line, b);
1254 };
1255 gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
1256 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1257 validator = do_validate;
1258
1259 cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
1260 }
1261 }
1262
1263 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1264 do anything. */
1265 if (b->commands != cmd)
1266 {
1267 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1268 b->commands = cmd;
1269 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1270 }
1271 });
1272 }
1273
1274 static void
1275 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1276 {
1277 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1278 }
1279
1280 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1281 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1282
1283 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1284 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1285 enum command_control_type
1286 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1287 {
1288 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1289 return simple_control;
1290 }
1291
1292 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1293
1294 static int
1295 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1296 {
1297 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1298 return 0;
1299 if (!bl->inserted)
1300 return 0;
1301 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1302 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1303 return 0;
1304 return 1;
1305 }
1306
1307 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1308 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1309 contents.
1310
1311 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1312 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1313 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1314
1315 static void
1316 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1317 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1318 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1319 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1320 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1321 {
1322 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1323 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1324 int bp_size = 0;
1325 int bptoffset = 0;
1326
1327 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1328 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1329 {
1330 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1331 return;
1332 }
1333
1334 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1335 we need to copy. */
1336 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1337 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1338
1339 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1340 {
1341 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1342 reading. */
1343 return;
1344 }
1345
1346 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1347 {
1348 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1349 reading. */
1350 return;
1351 }
1352
1353 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1354 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1355 {
1356 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1357 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1358 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1359 bp_addr = memaddr;
1360 }
1361
1362 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1363 {
1364 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1365 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1366 }
1367
1368 if (readbuf != NULL)
1369 {
1370 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1371 shadow_contents buffer. */
1372 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1373 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1374 + target_info->shadow_len));
1375
1376 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1377 shadow. */
1378 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1379 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1380 }
1381 else
1382 {
1383 const unsigned char *bp;
1384 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1385 int placed_size;
1386
1387 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1388 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1389 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1390
1391 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1392 address. */
1393 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1394
1395 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1396 breakpoint's INSN. */
1397 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1398 }
1399 }
1400
1401 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1402 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1403
1404 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1405 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1406 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1407
1408 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1409 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1410 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1411 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1412 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1413 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1414 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1415 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1416 and:
1417 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1418
1419 void
1420 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1421 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1422 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1423 {
1424 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1425 search. */
1426 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1427
1428 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1429 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1430 report higher one. */
1431
1432 bc_l = 0;
1433 bc_r = bp_locations_count;
1434 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1435 {
1436 struct bp_location *bl;
1437
1438 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1439 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1440
1441 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1442 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1443 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1444 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1445
1446 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1447 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1448 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1449
1450 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1451 >= bl->address)
1452 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1453 <= memaddr))
1454 bc_l = bc;
1455 else
1456 bc_r = bc;
1457 }
1458
1459 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1460 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1461 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1462 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1463 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1464 B:
1465
1466 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1467
1468 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1469 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1470 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1471 and L2. */
1472 while (bc_l > 0
1473 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1474 bc_l--;
1475
1476 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1477
1478 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations_count; bc++)
1479 {
1480 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1481
1482 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1483 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1484 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1485 bl->owner->number);
1486
1487 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1488 content. */
1489
1490 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1491 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1492 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))
1493 break;
1494
1495 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1496 continue;
1497
1498 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1499 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1500 }
1501 }
1502
1503 \f
1504
1505 /* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1506 breakpoint. */
1507
1508 int
1509 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1510 {
1511 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1512 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1513 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1514 }
1515
1516 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1517
1518 static int
1519 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1520 {
1521 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1522 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1523 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1524 }
1525
1526 /* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1527 software. */
1528
1529 int
1530 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1531 {
1532 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1533 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1534 }
1535
1536 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1537 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1538 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1539 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1540 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1541 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1542 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1543 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1544
1545 static int
1546 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1547 {
1548 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1549 && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
1550 || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
1551 && !inferior_thread ()->executing)));
1552 }
1553
1554 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1555 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1556
1557 static void
1558 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1559 {
1560 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1561 {
1562 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1563 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1564 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1565 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1566 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1567 }
1568 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1569 }
1570
1571 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1572 watchpoint W. */
1573
1574 static struct value *
1575 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1576 {
1577 struct value *bit_val;
1578
1579 if (val == NULL)
1580 return NULL;
1581
1582 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1583
1584 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1585 w->val_bitpos,
1586 w->val_bitsize,
1587 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1588 value_offset (val),
1589 val);
1590
1591 return bit_val;
1592 }
1593
1594 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1595 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1596 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1597 to be able to report stops. */
1598
1599 static void
1600 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1601 struct program_space *pspace)
1602 {
1603 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1604
1605 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1606 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1607 b->loc->address = -1;
1608 b->loc->length = -1;
1609 }
1610
1611 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1612 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1613
1614 static int
1615 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1616 {
1617 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1618 && b->loc != NULL
1619 && b->loc->next == NULL
1620 && b->loc->address == -1
1621 && b->loc->length == -1);
1622 }
1623
1624 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1625 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1626 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1627 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1628 in b->loc->cond.
1629 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1630
1631 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1632 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1633 it.
1634
1635 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1636 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1637 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1638 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1639 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1640 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1641 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1642 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1643
1644 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1645 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1646 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1647 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1648 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1649 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1650 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1651 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1652 not changed.
1653
1654 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1655 hardware watchpoints:
1656
1657 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1658 called several times when GDB stops.
1659
1660 [linux]
1661 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1662 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1663 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1664 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1665 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1666 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1667 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1668 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1669 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1670 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1671 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1672
1673 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1674 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1675
1676 static void
1677 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1678 {
1679 int within_current_scope;
1680 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1681 int frame_saved;
1682
1683 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1684 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1685 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1686 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1687 return;
1688
1689 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1690 return;
1691
1692 frame_saved = 0;
1693
1694 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1695 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1696 within_current_scope = 1;
1697 else
1698 {
1699 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1700 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1701 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1702
1703 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1704 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1705 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1706 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1707 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1708 return;
1709
1710 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1711 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1712 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1713 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1714 selected frame. */
1715 frame_saved = 1;
1716 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1717
1718 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1719 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1720 if (within_current_scope)
1721 select_frame (fi);
1722 }
1723
1724 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1725 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1726 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1727 b->loc = NULL;
1728
1729 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1730 {
1731 const char *s;
1732
1733 b->exp.reset ();
1734 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1735 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1736 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1737 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1738 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1739 be completely different objects. */
1740 b->val = NULL;
1741 b->val_valid = 0;
1742
1743 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1744 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1745 locations (re)created below. */
1746 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1747 {
1748 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1749
1750 s = b->cond_string;
1751 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1752 }
1753 }
1754
1755 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1756 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1757 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1758 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1759 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1760 if (!target_has_execution)
1761 {
1762 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1763 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1764 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1765 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1766 {
1767 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1768 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1769 else
1770 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1771 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1772 }
1773 }
1774 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1775 {
1776 int pc = 0;
1777 std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
1778 struct value *v, *result, *next;
1779 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1780
1781 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1782
1783 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1784 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1785 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1786 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1787 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1788 watchpoints. */
1789 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1790 {
1791 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1792 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1793 b->val = release_value (v);
1794 b->val_valid = 1;
1795 }
1796
1797 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1798
1799 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1800 gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
1801 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
1802 {
1803 v = iter.get ();
1804
1805 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1806 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1807 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1808 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1809 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1810 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1811 && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
1812 {
1813 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1814
1815 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1816 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1817 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1818 if (v == result
1819 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1820 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1821 {
1822 CORE_ADDR addr;
1823 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1824 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1825 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1826
1827 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1828 {
1829 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1830 sub-expression. */
1831 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1832 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1833 }
1834 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1835 {
1836 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1837 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1838 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1839 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1840 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1841 }
1842
1843 addr = value_address (v);
1844 if (bitsize != 0)
1845 {
1846 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1847 addr += bitpos / 8;
1848 }
1849
1850 type = hw_write;
1851 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1852 type = hw_read;
1853 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1854 type = hw_access;
1855
1856 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1857 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1858 ;
1859 *tmp = loc;
1860 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1861
1862 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1863 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1864
1865 if (bitsize != 0)
1866 {
1867 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1868 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1869 }
1870 else
1871 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1872
1873 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
1874 }
1875 }
1876 }
1877
1878 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
1879 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
1880 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
1881 is started. */
1882 if (reparse)
1883 {
1884 int reg_cnt;
1885 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
1886 struct bp_location *bl;
1887
1888 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
1889
1890 if (reg_cnt)
1891 {
1892 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
1893 enum bptype type;
1894
1895 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
1896 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
1897 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
1898
1899 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
1900 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
1901 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
1902 this watchpoint in as well. */
1903
1904 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
1905 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
1906 hardware watchpoint type. */
1907 type = b->type;
1908 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
1909 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
1910
1911 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
1912 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
1913 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
1914 through watch_command), so always account for it
1915 manually. */
1916
1917 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
1918 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
1919
1920 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
1921 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
1922
1923 target_resources_ok
1924 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
1925 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
1926 {
1927 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
1928
1929 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
1930 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
1931 "hardware watchpoint."));
1932 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
1933 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
1934 "resources for this watchpoint."));
1935
1936 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
1937 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1938 }
1939 else
1940 {
1941 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
1942 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
1943 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
1944 nop. */
1945 b->type = type;
1946 }
1947 }
1948 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1949 {
1950 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1951 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1952 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1953 else
1954 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
1955 "read/access watchpoint."));
1956 }
1957 else
1958 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1959
1960 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
1961 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
1962 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
1963 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
1964 }
1965
1966 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
1967 above left it without any location set up. But,
1968 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
1969 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
1970 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
1971 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
1972 }
1973 else if (!within_current_scope)
1974 {
1975 printf_filtered (_("\
1976 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
1977 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
1978 b->number);
1979 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
1980 }
1981
1982 /* Restore the selected frame. */
1983 if (frame_saved)
1984 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
1985 }
1986
1987
1988 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
1989 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
1990 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
1991 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
1992 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
1993 static int
1994 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
1995 {
1996 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
1997 return 0;
1998
1999 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2000 return 0;
2001
2002 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2003 return 0;
2004
2005 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2006 return 0;
2007
2008 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2009 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2010 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2011 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2012 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2013 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2014 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2015 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2016 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2017 return 0;
2018
2019 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2020 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2021 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2022 a breakpoint. */
2023 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2024 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2025 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2026 bl->address)
2027 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2028 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2029 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2030 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2031 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2032 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2033 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2034 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2035 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2036 {
2037 if (debug_infrun)
2038 {
2039 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2040 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2041 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2042 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2043 }
2044 return 0;
2045 }
2046
2047 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2048 instruction that triggered one. */
2049 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2050 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2051 {
2052 if (debug_infrun)
2053 {
2054 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2055 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2056 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2057 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2058 bl->length);
2059 }
2060 return 0;
2061 }
2062
2063 return 1;
2064 }
2065
2066 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2067 that the location is not duplicated. */
2068
2069 static int
2070 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2071 {
2072 int result;
2073 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2074
2075 bl->duplicate = 0;
2076 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2077 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2078 return result;
2079 }
2080
2081 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2082 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2083 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2084 any error during parsing. */
2085
2086 static agent_expr_up
2087 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2088 {
2089 if (cond == NULL)
2090 return NULL;
2091
2092 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2093
2094 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2095 that may show up. */
2096 TRY
2097 {
2098 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2099 }
2100
2101 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2102 {
2103 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2104 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2105 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2106 }
2107 END_CATCH
2108
2109 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2110 return aexpr;
2111 }
2112
2113 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2114 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2115 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2116 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2117 one of them is true. */
2118
2119 static void
2120 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2121 {
2122 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2123 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2124 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2125 struct bp_location *loc;
2126
2127 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2128 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2129
2130 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2131 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2132 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2133 side. */
2134 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2135 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2136 return;
2137
2138 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2139 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2140 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2141 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2142 response back to GDB. */
2143 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2144 {
2145 loc = (*loc2p);
2146 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2147 {
2148 if (modified)
2149 {
2150 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2151 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2152 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2153 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2154 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2155 loc->cond.get ());
2156 }
2157
2158 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2159 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2160 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2161 {
2162 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2163 break;
2164 }
2165 }
2166 }
2167
2168 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2169 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2170 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2171
2172 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2173 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2174 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2175 {
2176 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2177 {
2178 loc = (*loc2p);
2179 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2180 {
2181 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2182 located. */
2183 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2184 return;
2185
2186 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2187 }
2188 }
2189 }
2190
2191 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2192 for this location's address. */
2193 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2194 {
2195 loc = (*loc2p);
2196 if (loc->cond
2197 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2198 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2199 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2200 && loc->enabled)
2201 {
2202 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2203 to send the conditions to the target. */
2204 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2205 }
2206 }
2207
2208 return;
2209 }
2210
2211 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2212 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2213 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2214
2215 static agent_expr_up
2216 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2217 {
2218 const char *cmdrest;
2219 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2220 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2221
2222 if (cmd == NULL)
2223 return NULL;
2224
2225 cmdrest = cmd;
2226
2227 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2228 ++cmdrest;
2229 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2230
2231 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2232 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2233
2234 format_start = cmdrest;
2235
2236 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2237
2238 format_end = cmdrest;
2239
2240 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2241 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2242
2243 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2244
2245 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2246 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2247
2248 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2249 cmdrest++;
2250 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2251
2252 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2253
2254 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2255 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2256 {
2257 const char *cmd1;
2258
2259 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2260 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2261 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2262 cmdrest = cmd1;
2263 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2264 ++cmdrest;
2265 }
2266
2267 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2268
2269 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2270 that may show up. */
2271 TRY
2272 {
2273 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2274 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2275 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2276 }
2277 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2278 {
2279 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2280 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2281 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2282 }
2283 END_CATCH
2284
2285 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2286 return aexpr;
2287 }
2288
2289 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2290 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2291 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2292
2293 static void
2294 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2295 {
2296 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2297 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2298 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2299 struct bp_location *loc;
2300
2301 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2302 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2303
2304 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2305 return;
2306
2307 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2308 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2309 return;
2310
2311 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2312 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2313 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2314 control. */
2315 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2316 {
2317 loc = (*loc2p);
2318 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2319 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2320 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2321 return;
2322 }
2323
2324 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2325 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2326 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2327 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2328 response back to GDB. */
2329 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2330 {
2331 loc = (*loc2p);
2332 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2333 {
2334 if (modified)
2335 {
2336 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2337 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2338 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2339 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2340 loc->cmd_bytecode
2341 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2342 loc->owner->extra_string);
2343 }
2344
2345 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2346 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2347 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2348 {
2349 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2350 break;
2351 }
2352 }
2353 }
2354
2355 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2356 and so clean up. */
2357 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2358 {
2359 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2360 {
2361 loc = (*loc2p);
2362 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2363 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2364 {
2365 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2366 located. */
2367 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2368 return;
2369
2370 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2371 }
2372 }
2373 }
2374
2375 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2376 for this location's address. */
2377 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2378 {
2379 loc = (*loc2p);
2380 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2381 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2382 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2383 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2384 && loc->enabled)
2385 {
2386 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2387 to send the commands to the target. */
2388 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2389 }
2390 }
2391
2392 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2393 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2394 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2395 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2396 }
2397
2398 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2399 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2400 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2401 registers state. */
2402
2403 static int
2404 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2405 {
2406 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2407 {
2408 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2409 struct regcache *regcache;
2410
2411 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
2412
2413 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2414 regcache, addr);
2415 }
2416 else
2417 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2418 }
2419
2420 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2421 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2422 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2423 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2424 -1 for failure.
2425
2426 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2427 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2428 static int
2429 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2430 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2431 int *disabled_breaks,
2432 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2433 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2434 {
2435 gdb_exception bp_excpt = exception_none;
2436
2437 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2438 return 0;
2439
2440 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2441 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2442 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2443 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2444 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2445 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2446 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2447 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2448 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2449 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2450 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2451 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2452
2453 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2454 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2455 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2456 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2457
2458 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2459 {
2460 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2461 build_target_command_list (bl);
2462 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2463 bl->needs_update = 0;
2464 }
2465
2466 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2467 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2468 {
2469 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2470 {
2471 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2472 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2473 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2474
2475 Two important cases are:
2476 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2477 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2478 hardware breakpoint.
2479 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2480 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2481 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2482 so we undo.
2483
2484 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2485 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2486 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2487 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2488 gdb. */
2489 struct mem_region *mr
2490 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2491
2492 if (mr)
2493 {
2494 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2495 {
2496 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2497
2498 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2499 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2500 else
2501 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2502
2503 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2504 {
2505 static int said = 0;
2506
2507 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2508 if (!said)
2509 {
2510 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2511 _("Note: automatically using "
2512 "hardware breakpoints for "
2513 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2514 said = 1;
2515 }
2516 }
2517 }
2518 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2519 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2520 {
2521 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2522 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2523 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2524 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2525 bl->owner->number,
2526 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2527 return 1;
2528 }
2529 }
2530 }
2531
2532 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2533 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2534 || bl->section == NULL
2535 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2536 {
2537 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2538 TRY
2539 {
2540 int val;
2541
2542 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2543 if (val)
2544 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2545 }
2546 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2547 {
2548 bp_excpt = e;
2549 }
2550 END_CATCH
2551 }
2552 else
2553 {
2554 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2555 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2556 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2557 {
2558 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2559 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2560 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2561 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2562 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2563 bl->owner->number);
2564 else
2565 {
2566 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2567 bl->section);
2568 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2569 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2570 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2571
2572 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2573 TRY
2574 {
2575 int val;
2576
2577 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2578 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2579 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2580 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2581 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2582 if (val)
2583 bp_excpt
2584 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2585 }
2586 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2587 {
2588 bp_excpt = e;
2589 }
2590 END_CATCH
2591
2592 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2593 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2594 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2595 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2596 bl->owner->number);
2597 }
2598 }
2599 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2600 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2601 {
2602 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2603 TRY
2604 {
2605 int val;
2606
2607 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2608 if (val)
2609 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2610 }
2611 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2612 {
2613 bp_excpt = e;
2614 }
2615 END_CATCH
2616 }
2617 else
2618 {
2619 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2620 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2621 return 0;
2622 }
2623 }
2624
2625 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2626 {
2627 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2628
2629 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2630 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2631 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2632 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2633 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2634 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2635 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2636 errors as memory errors. */
2637 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2638 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2639 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2640 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2641 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2642 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2643 bl->address)))
2644 {
2645 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2646 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2647 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
2648 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2649 {
2650 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2651 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2652 bl->owner->number);
2653 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2654 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2655 "library breakpoints:\n");
2656 }
2657 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2658 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2659 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2660 return 0;
2661 }
2662 else
2663 {
2664 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2665 {
2666 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2667 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2668 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2669 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2670 bl->owner->number,
2671 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2672 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2673 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2674 bp_excpt.message);
2675 }
2676 else
2677 {
2678 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2679 {
2680 std::string message
2681 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2682 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2683
2684 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2685 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2686 "%s\n",
2687 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2688 }
2689 else
2690 {
2691 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2692 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2693 bl->owner->number,
2694 bp_excpt.message);
2695 }
2696 }
2697 return 1;
2698
2699 }
2700 }
2701 else
2702 bl->inserted = 1;
2703
2704 return 0;
2705 }
2706
2707 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2708 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2709 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2710 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2711 {
2712 int val;
2713
2714 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2715 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2716
2717 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2718
2719 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2720 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2721 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2722 {
2723 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2724
2725 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2726 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2727 of this one. */
2728 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2729 if (loc != bl
2730 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2731 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2732 {
2733 bl->duplicate = 1;
2734 bl->inserted = 1;
2735 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2736 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2737 val = 0;
2738 break;
2739 }
2740
2741 if (val == 1)
2742 {
2743 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2744 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2745
2746 if (val)
2747 /* Back to the original value. */
2748 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2749 }
2750 }
2751
2752 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2753 }
2754
2755 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2756 {
2757 int val;
2758
2759 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2760 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2761
2762 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2763 if (val)
2764 {
2765 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2766
2767 if (val == 1)
2768 warning (_("\
2769 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2770 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2771 else
2772 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2773 }
2774
2775 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2776
2777 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2778 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2779 so just return success. */
2780 return 0;
2781 }
2782
2783 return 0;
2784 }
2785
2786 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2787 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2788 PSPACE anymore. */
2789
2790 void
2791 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2792 {
2793 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2794 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2795
2796 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2797 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2798 {
2799 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2800 delete_breakpoint (b);
2801 }
2802
2803 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2804 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2805 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2806 {
2807 struct bp_location *tmp;
2808
2809 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2810 {
2811 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2812 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2813 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2814 else
2815 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2816 if (tmp->next == loc)
2817 {
2818 tmp->next = loc->next;
2819 break;
2820 }
2821 }
2822 }
2823
2824 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2825 removed locations above. */
2826 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2827 }
2828
2829 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2830 Throws exception on any error.
2831 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2832 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2833 void
2834 insert_breakpoints (void)
2835 {
2836 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2837
2838 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2839 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2840 {
2841 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2842
2843 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2844 }
2845
2846 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2847 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2848 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
2849 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2850 }
2851
2852 /* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2853
2854 void
2855 iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2856 {
2857 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2858
2859 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2860 {
2861 callback (loc, NULL);
2862 }
2863 }
2864
2865 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2866 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2867 always-inserted mode. */
2868
2869 static void
2870 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2871 {
2872 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2873 int error_flag = 0;
2874 int val = 0;
2875 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2876 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2877 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2878
2879 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2880
2881 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2882 there was an error. */
2883 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2884
2885 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2886
2887 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2888 {
2889 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2890 breakpoints. */
2891 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2892 continue;
2893
2894 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2895 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2896 deletion of breakpoints. */
2897 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2898 continue;
2899
2900 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2901
2902 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2903 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2904 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2905 insert breakpoints. */
2906 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2907 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2908 continue;
2909
2910 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2911 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2912 if (val)
2913 error_flag = val;
2914 }
2915
2916 if (error_flag)
2917 {
2918 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2919 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2920 }
2921 }
2922
2923 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2924
2925 static void
2926 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2927 {
2928 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2929 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
2930 int error_flag = 0;
2931 int val = 0;
2932 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2933 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2934 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2935
2936 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2937
2938 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2939 there was an error. */
2940 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2941
2942 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2943
2944 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
2945 {
2946 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2947 continue;
2948
2949 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
2950 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
2951 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2952 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
2953 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
2954 continue;
2955
2956 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2957
2958 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2959 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2960 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2961 insert breakpoints. */
2962 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2963 && inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
2964 continue;
2965
2966 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2967 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
2968 if (val)
2969 error_flag = val;
2970 }
2971
2972 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
2973 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
2974 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2975 {
2976 int some_failed = 0;
2977 struct bp_location *loc;
2978
2979 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2980 continue;
2981
2982 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
2983 continue;
2984
2985 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2986 continue;
2987
2988 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2989 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
2990 {
2991 some_failed = 1;
2992 break;
2993 }
2994 if (some_failed)
2995 {
2996 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
2997 if (loc->inserted)
2998 remove_breakpoint (loc);
2999
3000 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3001 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3002 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3003 bpt->number);
3004 error_flag = -1;
3005 }
3006 }
3007
3008 if (error_flag)
3009 {
3010 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3011 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3012 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3013 {
3014 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3015 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3016 }
3017 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3018 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3019 }
3020 }
3021
3022 /* Used when the program stops.
3023 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3024 removing a breakpoint location. */
3025
3026 int
3027 remove_breakpoints (void)
3028 {
3029 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3030 int val = 0;
3031
3032 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3033 {
3034 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3035 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3036 }
3037 return val;
3038 }
3039
3040 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3041 that thread. */
3042
3043 static void
3044 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3045 {
3046 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3047
3048 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3049 {
3050 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3051 {
3052 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3053
3054 printf_filtered (_("\
3055 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3056 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3057
3058 /* Hide it from the user. */
3059 b->number = 0;
3060 }
3061 }
3062 }
3063
3064 /* Remove breakpoints of inferior INF. */
3065
3066 int
3067 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
3068 {
3069 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3070 int val;
3071
3072 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3073 {
3074 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3075 continue;
3076
3077 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3078 {
3079 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3080 if (val != 0)
3081 return val;
3082 }
3083 }
3084 return 0;
3085 }
3086
3087 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3088
3089 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3090 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3091 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3092 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3093 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3094 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3095 static void
3096 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3097 {
3098 if (internal)
3099 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3100 else
3101 {
3102 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3103 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3104 }
3105 }
3106
3107 static struct breakpoint *
3108 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3109 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3110 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3111 {
3112 symtab_and_line sal;
3113 sal.pc = address;
3114 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3115 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3116
3117 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3118 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3119 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3120
3121 return b;
3122 }
3123
3124 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3125 {
3126 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3127 };
3128 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3129
3130 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3131 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3132 {
3133 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3134 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3135
3136 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3137 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3138
3139 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3140 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3141
3142 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3143 references. */
3144 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3145
3146 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3147 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3148
3149 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3150 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3151
3152 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3153 int exception_searched = 0;
3154
3155 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3156 references. */
3157 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3158 };
3159
3160 static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3161
3162 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3163 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3164
3165 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3166
3167 static int
3168 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3169 {
3170 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3171 }
3172
3173 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3174 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3175
3176 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3177 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3178 {
3179 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3180
3181 bp_objfile_data = ((struct breakpoint_objfile_data *)
3182 objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key));
3183 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3184 {
3185 bp_objfile_data = new breakpoint_objfile_data ();
3186 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3187 }
3188 return bp_objfile_data;
3189 }
3190
3191 static void
3192 free_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3193 {
3194 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3195 = (struct breakpoint_objfile_data *) data;
3196
3197 delete bp_objfile_data;
3198 }
3199
3200 static void
3201 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3202 {
3203 struct objfile *objfile;
3204 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3205
3206 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3207 {
3208 struct breakpoint *b;
3209 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3210 CORE_ADDR addr;
3211 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3212
3213 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3214
3215 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3216 continue;
3217
3218 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3219 {
3220 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3221
3222 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3223 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3224 {
3225 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3226 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3227 continue;
3228 }
3229 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3230 }
3231
3232 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3233 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3234 bp_overlay_event,
3235 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3236 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3237 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3238 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3239
3240 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3241 {
3242 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3243 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3244 }
3245 else
3246 {
3247 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3248 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3249 }
3250 }
3251 }
3252
3253 static void
3254 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3255 {
3256 struct program_space *pspace;
3257
3258 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3259
3260 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3261 {
3262 struct objfile *objfile;
3263
3264 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3265
3266 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3267 {
3268 int i;
3269 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3270 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3271
3272 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3273
3274 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3275
3276 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3277 {
3278 std::vector<probe *> ret
3279 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3280
3281 if (!ret.empty ())
3282 {
3283 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3284 probe *p = ret[0];
3285
3286 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3287 {
3288 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3289 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3290 ret.clear ();
3291 }
3292 }
3293 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3294 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3295 }
3296
3297 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3298 {
3299 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3300
3301 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3302 {
3303 struct breakpoint *b;
3304
3305 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3306 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3307 bp_longjmp_master,
3308 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3309 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3310 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3311 }
3312
3313 continue;
3314 }
3315
3316 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3317 continue;
3318
3319 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3320 {
3321 struct breakpoint *b;
3322 const char *func_name;
3323 CORE_ADDR addr;
3324 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3325
3326 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3327 continue;
3328
3329 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3330 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3331 {
3332 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3333
3334 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3335 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3336 {
3337 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3338 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3339 continue;
3340 }
3341 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3342 }
3343
3344 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3345 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3346 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3347 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3348 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3349 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3350 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3351 }
3352 }
3353 }
3354 }
3355
3356 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3357 static void
3358 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3359 {
3360 struct program_space *pspace;
3361 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3362
3363 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3364
3365 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3366 {
3367 struct objfile *objfile;
3368 CORE_ADDR addr;
3369
3370 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3371
3372 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3373 {
3374 struct breakpoint *b;
3375 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3376 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3377
3378 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3379
3380 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3381 continue;
3382
3383 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3384 {
3385 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3386
3387 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3388 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3389 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3390 {
3391 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3392 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3393 continue;
3394 }
3395 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3396 }
3397
3398 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3399 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3400 bp_std_terminate_master,
3401 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3402 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3403 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3404 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3405 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3406 }
3407 }
3408 }
3409
3410 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3411
3412 static void
3413 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3414 {
3415 struct objfile *objfile;
3416 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3417
3418 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3419 {
3420 struct breakpoint *b;
3421 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3422 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3423 CORE_ADDR addr;
3424 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3425
3426 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3427
3428 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3429 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3430 {
3431 std::vector<probe *> ret
3432 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3433
3434 if (!ret.empty ())
3435 {
3436 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3437 probe *p = ret[0];
3438
3439 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3440 {
3441 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3442 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3443 ret.clear ();
3444 }
3445 }
3446 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3447 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3448 }
3449
3450 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3451 {
3452 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3453
3454 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3455 {
3456 struct breakpoint *b;
3457
3458 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3459 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3460 bp_exception_master,
3461 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3462 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3463 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3464 }
3465
3466 continue;
3467 }
3468
3469 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3470
3471 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3472 continue;
3473
3474 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3475
3476 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3477 {
3478 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3479
3480 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3481 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3482 {
3483 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3484 continue;
3485 }
3486
3487 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3488 }
3489
3490 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3491 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3492 current_top_target ());
3493 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3494 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3495 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3496 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3497 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3498 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3499 }
3500 }
3501
3502 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3503
3504 static int
3505 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3506 {
3507 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3508 }
3509
3510 void
3511 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3512 {
3513 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3514 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3515
3516 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3517 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3518 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3519 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3520 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3521 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3522 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3523 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3524 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3525 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3526 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3527
3528 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3529 {
3530 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3531 continue;
3532
3533 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3534 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3535 {
3536 delete_breakpoint (b);
3537 continue;
3538 }
3539
3540 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3541 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3542 {
3543 delete_breakpoint (b);
3544 continue;
3545 }
3546
3547 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3548 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3549 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3550 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3551 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3552 {
3553 delete_breakpoint (b);
3554 continue;
3555 }
3556
3557 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3558 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3559 {
3560 delete_breakpoint (b);
3561 continue;
3562 }
3563
3564 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3565 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3566 {
3567 delete_breakpoint (b);
3568 continue;
3569 }
3570
3571 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3572 after an exec. */
3573 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3574 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3575 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3576 {
3577 delete_breakpoint (b);
3578 continue;
3579 }
3580
3581 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3582 {
3583 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3584 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3585 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3586 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3587 continue;
3588 }
3589
3590 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3591 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3592 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3593 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3594 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3595 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3596
3597 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3598 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3599 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3600 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3601 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3602 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3603 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3604
3605 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3606 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3607 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3608 let finish_command delete it.
3609
3610 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3611 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3612 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3613 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3614 solib breakpoints.) */
3615
3616 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3617 {
3618 continue;
3619 }
3620
3621 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3622 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3623 a.out. */
3624 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3625 {
3626 delete_breakpoint (b);
3627 continue;
3628 }
3629 }
3630 }
3631
3632 int
3633 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3634 {
3635 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3636 int val = 0;
3637 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3638 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3639
3640 if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
3641 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3642
3643 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3644 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3645 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3646 {
3647 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3648 continue;
3649
3650 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3651 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3652 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3653 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3654 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3655 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3656 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3657 continue;
3658
3659 if (bl->inserted)
3660 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3661 }
3662
3663 return val;
3664 }
3665
3666 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3667 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3668 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3669 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3670 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3671
3672 static int
3673 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3674 {
3675 int val;
3676
3677 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3678 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3679
3680 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3681 This should not ever happen. */
3682 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3683
3684 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3685 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3686 {
3687 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3688 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3689 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3690
3691 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3692 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3693 || bl->section == NULL
3694 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3695 {
3696 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3697
3698 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3699 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3700 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3701 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3702 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3703 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3704 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3705 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3706 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3707 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3708 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3709 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3710 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3711 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3712 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3713 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3714 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3715 they should always be removed. */
3716 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3717 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3718 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3719 val = 0;
3720 else
3721 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3722 }
3723 else
3724 {
3725 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3726 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3727 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3728 {
3729 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3730 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3731 */
3732 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3733 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3734 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3735 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3736 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3737 else
3738 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3739 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3740 reason);
3741 }
3742 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3743 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3744 if (bl->inserted)
3745 {
3746 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3747 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3748 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3749 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3750
3751 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3752 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3753 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3754 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3755 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3756 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3757 else
3758 val = 0;
3759 }
3760 else
3761 {
3762 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3763 val = 0;
3764 }
3765 }
3766
3767 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3768 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3769 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3770 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3771 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3772 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3773 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3774 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3775 always-inserted mode. */
3776 if (val
3777 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3778 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3779 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3780 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3781 bl->address))))
3782 val = 0;
3783
3784 if (val)
3785 return val;
3786 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3787 }
3788 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3789 {
3790 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3791 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3792
3793 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3794 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3795
3796 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3797 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3798 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3799 bl->owner->number);
3800 }
3801 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3802 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3803 && !bl->duplicate)
3804 {
3805 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3806 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3807
3808 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3809 if (val)
3810 return val;
3811
3812 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3813 }
3814
3815 return 0;
3816 }
3817
3818 static int
3819 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3820 {
3821 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3822 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3823
3824 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3825 This should not ever happen. */
3826 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3827
3828 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3829
3830 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3831
3832 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3833 }
3834
3835 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3836
3837 void
3838 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3839 {
3840 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3841
3842 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3843 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3844 bl->inserted = 0;
3845 }
3846
3847 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3848 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3849
3850 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3851 between runs.
3852
3853 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3854 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3855 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3856
3857
3858
3859 void
3860 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3861 {
3862 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3863 struct bp_location *bl;
3864 int ix;
3865 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3866
3867 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3868 nothing to do. */
3869 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3870 return;
3871
3872 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3873
3874 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3875 {
3876 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3877 continue;
3878
3879 switch (b->type)
3880 {
3881 case bp_call_dummy:
3882 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3883
3884 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3885 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3886 rid of it. */
3887
3888 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3889
3890 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3891
3892 case bp_shlib_event:
3893
3894 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3895 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3896 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3897 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3898 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3899
3900 (gdb) file prog-linux
3901 (gdb) run # native linux target
3902 ...
3903 (gdb) kill
3904 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3905 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3906 */
3907
3908 case bp_step_resume:
3909
3910 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3911
3912 case bp_single_step:
3913
3914 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3915
3916 delete_breakpoint (b);
3917 break;
3918
3919 case bp_watchpoint:
3920 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
3921 case bp_read_watchpoint:
3922 case bp_access_watchpoint:
3923 {
3924 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
3925
3926 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
3927 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
3928 delete_breakpoint (b);
3929 else
3930 {
3931 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
3932 valid. New ones will be created in
3933 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
3934 The next update_global_location_list call will
3935 garbage collect them. */
3936 b->loc = NULL;
3937
3938 if (context == inf_starting)
3939 {
3940 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
3941 insert_breakpoints. */
3942 w->val.reset (nullptr);
3943 w->val_valid = 0;
3944 }
3945 }
3946 }
3947 break;
3948 default:
3949 break;
3950 }
3951 }
3952
3953 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
3954 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
3955 decref_bp_location (&bl);
3956 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
3957 }
3958
3959 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
3960 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
3961 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
3962 match, not program space. */
3963
3964 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
3965 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
3966 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
3967 permanent breakpoint.
3968 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
3969 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
3970 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
3971 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
3972 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
3973
3974 enum breakpoint_here
3975 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
3976 {
3977 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3978 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
3979
3980 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3981 {
3982 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3983 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3984 continue;
3985
3986 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3987 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3988 || bl->permanent)
3989 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
3990 {
3991 if (overlay_debugging
3992 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
3993 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3994 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
3995 else if (bl->permanent)
3996 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
3997 else
3998 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
3999 }
4000 }
4001
4002 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4003 }
4004
4005 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4006
4007 int
4008 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
4009 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4010 {
4011 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4012
4013 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4014 {
4015 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4016 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4017 continue;
4018
4019 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4020 || bl->permanent)
4021 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4022 addr, len))
4023 {
4024 if (overlay_debugging
4025 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4026 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4027 {
4028 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4029 continue;
4030 }
4031
4032 return 1;
4033 }
4034 }
4035
4036 return 0;
4037 }
4038
4039 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4040
4041 int
4042 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4043 {
4044 struct bp_location *loc;
4045 int ix;
4046
4047 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4048 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4049 return 1;
4050
4051 return 0;
4052 }
4053
4054 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4055 ASPACE. */
4056
4057 static int
4058 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4059 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4060 {
4061 if (bl->inserted
4062 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4063 aspace, pc))
4064 {
4065 if (overlay_debugging
4066 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4067 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4068 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4069 else
4070 return 1;
4071 }
4072 return 0;
4073 }
4074
4075 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4076
4077 int
4078 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4079 {
4080 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4081
4082 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4083 {
4084 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4085
4086 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4087 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4088 continue;
4089
4090 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4091 return 1;
4092 }
4093 return 0;
4094 }
4095
4096 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4097 inserted at PC. */
4098
4099 int
4100 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4101 CORE_ADDR pc)
4102 {
4103 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4104
4105 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4106 {
4107 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4108
4109 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4110 continue;
4111
4112 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4113 return 1;
4114 }
4115
4116 return 0;
4117 }
4118
4119 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4120
4121 int
4122 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4123 CORE_ADDR pc)
4124 {
4125 struct bp_location **blp, **blp_tmp = NULL;
4126
4127 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (blp, blp_tmp, pc)
4128 {
4129 struct bp_location *bl = *blp;
4130
4131 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4132 continue;
4133
4134 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4135 return 1;
4136 }
4137
4138 return 0;
4139 }
4140
4141 int
4142 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4143 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4144 {
4145 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4146
4147 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4148 {
4149 struct bp_location *loc;
4150
4151 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4152 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4153 continue;
4154
4155 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4156 continue;
4157
4158 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4159 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4160 {
4161 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4162
4163 /* Check for intersection. */
4164 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4165 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4166 if (l < h)
4167 return 1;
4168 }
4169 }
4170 return 0;
4171 }
4172 \f
4173
4174 /* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4175 in breakpoint.h. */
4176
4177 int
4178 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4179 {
4180 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4181 }
4182
4183 /* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4184 'next' chain. */
4185
4186 bpstats::~bpstats ()
4187 {
4188 if (bp_location_at != NULL)
4189 decref_bp_location (&bp_location_at);
4190 }
4191
4192 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4193 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4194
4195 void
4196 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4197 {
4198 bpstat p;
4199 bpstat q;
4200
4201 if (bsp == 0)
4202 return;
4203 p = *bsp;
4204 while (p != NULL)
4205 {
4206 q = p->next;
4207 delete p;
4208 p = q;
4209 }
4210 *bsp = NULL;
4211 }
4212
4213 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4214 : next (NULL),
4215 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4216 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4217 commands (other.commands),
4218 print (other.print),
4219 stop (other.stop),
4220 print_it (other.print_it)
4221 {
4222 if (other.old_val != NULL)
4223 old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
4224 incref_bp_location (bp_location_at);
4225 }
4226
4227 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4228 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4229
4230 bpstat
4231 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4232 {
4233 bpstat p = NULL;
4234 bpstat tmp;
4235 bpstat retval = NULL;
4236
4237 if (bs == NULL)
4238 return bs;
4239
4240 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4241 {
4242 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4243
4244 if (p == NULL)
4245 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4246 retval = tmp;
4247 else
4248 p->next = tmp;
4249 p = tmp;
4250 }
4251 p->next = NULL;
4252 return retval;
4253 }
4254
4255 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4256
4257 bpstat
4258 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4259 {
4260 if (bsp == NULL)
4261 return NULL;
4262
4263 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4264 {
4265 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4266 return bsp;
4267 }
4268 return NULL;
4269 }
4270
4271 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4272
4273 int
4274 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4275 {
4276 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4277 {
4278 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4279 {
4280 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4281 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4282 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4283 return 1;
4284 }
4285 else
4286 {
4287 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4288 sig))
4289 return 1;
4290 }
4291 }
4292
4293 return 0;
4294 }
4295
4296 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4297 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4298 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4299 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4300
4301 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4302 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4303 we set it.
4304 Return 1 otherwise. */
4305
4306 int
4307 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4308 {
4309 struct breakpoint *b;
4310
4311 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4312 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4313
4314 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4315 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4316 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4317 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4318 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4319 if (b == NULL)
4320 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4321
4322 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4323 return 1;
4324 }
4325
4326 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4327
4328 void
4329 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4330 {
4331 bpstat bs;
4332
4333 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
4334 return;
4335
4336 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4337 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4338 {
4339 bs->commands = NULL;
4340 bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
4341 }
4342 }
4343
4344 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4345
4346 static void
4347 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4348 {
4349 if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
4350 {
4351 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4352
4353 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4354 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4355 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4356 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4357 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4358 return;
4359 }
4360
4361 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4362 }
4363
4364 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4365 or its equivalent. */
4366
4367 static int
4368 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4369 {
4370 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4371 }
4372
4373 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4374 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4375 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4376 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4377
4378 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4379 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4380 bpstat of the current thread. */
4381
4382 static int
4383 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4384 {
4385 bpstat bs;
4386 int again = 0;
4387
4388 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4389 in bs->commands. */
4390 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4391 return 0;
4392
4393 scoped_restore save_executing
4394 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4395
4396 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4397
4398 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4399 bs = *bsp;
4400
4401 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4402 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4403 {
4404 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4405
4406 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4407
4408 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4409 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4410 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4411 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4412 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4413 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4414 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4415 the tree when we're done. */
4416 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4417 bs->commands = NULL;
4418 if (ccmd != NULL)
4419 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4420 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4421 {
4422 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4423 cmd = cmd->next;
4424 }
4425
4426 while (cmd != NULL)
4427 {
4428 execute_control_command (cmd);
4429
4430 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4431 break;
4432 else
4433 cmd = cmd->next;
4434 }
4435
4436 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4437 {
4438 if (current_ui->async)
4439 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4440 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4441 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4442 ;
4443 else
4444 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4445 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4446 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4447 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4448 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4449 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4450 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4451 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4452 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4453 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4454 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4455 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4456 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4457 again = 1;
4458 break;
4459 }
4460 }
4461 return again;
4462 }
4463
4464 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4465 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4466
4467 static thread_info *
4468 get_bpstat_thread ()
4469 {
4470 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution)
4471 return NULL;
4472
4473 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4474 if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing)
4475 return NULL;
4476 return tp;
4477 }
4478
4479 void
4480 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4481 {
4482 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4483 thread_info *tp;
4484
4485 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4486 while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
4487 {
4488 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4489 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4490 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4491 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4492 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
4493 break;
4494 }
4495
4496 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4497 }
4498
4499 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4500
4501 static void
4502 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4503 {
4504 if (val == NULL)
4505 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4506 else
4507 {
4508 struct value_print_options opts;
4509 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4510 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4511 }
4512 }
4513
4514 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4515 debugging multiple threads. */
4516
4517 void
4518 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4519 {
4520 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4521 return;
4522
4523 uiout->text ("\n");
4524
4525 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4526 {
4527 const char *name;
4528 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4529
4530 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4531 uiout->field_fmt ("thread-id", "%s", print_thread_id (thr));
4532
4533 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4534 if (name != NULL)
4535 {
4536 uiout->text (" \"");
4537 uiout->field_fmt ("name", "%s", name);
4538 uiout->text ("\"");
4539 }
4540
4541 uiout->text (" hit ");
4542 }
4543 }
4544
4545 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4546 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4547 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4548 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4549 normal_stop(). */
4550
4551 static enum print_stop_action
4552 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4553 {
4554 switch (bs->print_it)
4555 {
4556 case print_it_noop:
4557 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4558 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4559 break;
4560
4561 case print_it_done:
4562 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4563 relevant messages. */
4564 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4565 break;
4566
4567 case print_it_normal:
4568 {
4569 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4570
4571 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4572 which has since been deleted. */
4573 if (b == NULL)
4574 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4575
4576 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4577 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4578 }
4579 break;
4580
4581 default:
4582 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4583 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4584 break;
4585 }
4586 }
4587
4588 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4589
4590 static void
4591 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4592 {
4593 bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
4594 bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
4595
4596 if (!is_catchpoint)
4597 {
4598 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4599 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4600 else
4601 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4602 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4603 }
4604
4605 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4606 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4607 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4608
4609 if (any_deleted)
4610 {
4611 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4612 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4613 for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
4614 {
4615 const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
4616
4617 if (ix > 0)
4618 current_uiout->text (" ");
4619 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4620 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4621 }
4622 }
4623
4624 if (any_added)
4625 {
4626 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4627 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4628 bool first = true;
4629 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
4630 {
4631 if (!first)
4632 current_uiout->text (" ");
4633 first = false;
4634 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4635 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4636 }
4637 }
4638 }
4639
4640 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4641 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4642 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4643 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4644 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4645 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4646 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4647 routine is one of:
4648
4649 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4650 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4651 code to print the location. An example is
4652 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4653 the location.
4654 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4655 to also print the location part of the message.
4656 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4657 don't require a location appended to the end.
4658 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4659 further info to be printed. */
4660
4661 enum print_stop_action
4662 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4663 {
4664 enum print_stop_action val;
4665
4666 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4667 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4668 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4669 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4670 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4671 {
4672 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4673 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4674 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4675 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4676 return val;
4677 }
4678
4679 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4680 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4681 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4682 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4683 {
4684 print_solib_event (0);
4685 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4686 }
4687
4688 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4689 with and nothing was printed. */
4690 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4691 }
4692
4693 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4694
4695 static bool
4696 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4697 {
4698 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4699 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4700
4701 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4702 return res;
4703 }
4704
4705 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4706
4707 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4708 : next (NULL),
4709 bp_location_at (bl),
4710 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4711 commands (NULL),
4712 print (0),
4713 stop (0),
4714 print_it (print_it_normal)
4715 {
4716 incref_bp_location (bl);
4717 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4718 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4719 }
4720
4721 bpstats::bpstats ()
4722 : next (NULL),
4723 bp_location_at (NULL),
4724 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4725 commands (NULL),
4726 print (0),
4727 stop (0),
4728 print_it (print_it_normal)
4729 {
4730 }
4731 \f
4732 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4733 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4734
4735 int
4736 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4737 {
4738 bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4739 CORE_ADDR addr;
4740 struct breakpoint *b;
4741
4742 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4743 {
4744 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4745 as not triggered. */
4746 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4747 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4748 {
4749 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4750
4751 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4752 }
4753
4754 return 0;
4755 }
4756
4757 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_top_target (), &addr))
4758 {
4759 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4760 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4761 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4762 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4763 {
4764 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4765
4766 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4767 }
4768
4769 return 1;
4770 }
4771
4772 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4773 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4774 triggered. */
4775
4776 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4777 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4778 {
4779 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4780 struct bp_location *loc;
4781
4782 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4783 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4784 {
4785 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4786 {
4787 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4788 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4789
4790 if (newaddr == start)
4791 {
4792 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4793 break;
4794 }
4795 }
4796 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4797 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (current_top_target (),
4798 addr, loc->address,
4799 loc->length))
4800 {
4801 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4802 break;
4803 }
4804 }
4805 }
4806
4807 return 1;
4808 }
4809
4810 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4811 enum wp_check_result
4812 {
4813 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4814 WP_DELETED = 1,
4815
4816 /* The value has changed. */
4817 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4818
4819 /* The value has not changed. */
4820 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4821
4822 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4823 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4824 };
4825
4826 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4827 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4828
4829 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4830 changed. */
4831
4832 static wp_check_result
4833 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4834 {
4835 struct watchpoint *b;
4836 struct frame_info *fr;
4837 int within_current_scope;
4838
4839 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4840 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4841 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4842
4843 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4844 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4845 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4846 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4847 return WP_IGNORE;
4848
4849 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4850 within_current_scope = 1;
4851 else
4852 {
4853 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4854 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4855 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4856
4857 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4858 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4859 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4860 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4861 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4862 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4863 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4864 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4865 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4866 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4867 return WP_IGNORE;
4868
4869 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4870 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4871
4872 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4873 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4874 if (within_current_scope)
4875 {
4876 struct symbol *function;
4877
4878 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4879 if (function == NULL
4880 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4881 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4882 within_current_scope = 0;
4883 }
4884
4885 if (within_current_scope)
4886 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4887 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4888 the user. */
4889 select_frame (fr);
4890 }
4891
4892 if (within_current_scope)
4893 {
4894 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4895 time before we return to the command level and call
4896 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4897 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4898
4899 int pc = 0;
4900 struct value *mark;
4901 struct value *new_val;
4902
4903 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4904 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4905 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4906 a mask watchpoint. */
4907 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4908
4909 mark = value_mark ();
4910 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
4911
4912 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4913 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4914
4915 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4916 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4917 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4918 not what we want. */
4919 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4920 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
4921 new_val)))
4922 {
4923 bs->old_val = b->val;
4924 b->val = release_value (new_val);
4925 b->val_valid = 1;
4926 if (new_val != NULL)
4927 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4928 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4929 }
4930 else
4931 {
4932 /* Nothing changed. */
4933 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4934 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4935 }
4936 }
4937 else
4938 {
4939 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4940 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4941 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4942 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4943 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4944 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4945 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4946 the first value assigned). */
4947 /* We print all the stop information in
4948 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4949 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4950 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4951 here. */
4952
4953 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4954 {
4955 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4956
4957 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4958 uiout->field_string
4959 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
4960 uiout->text ("\nWatchpoint ");
4961 uiout->field_int ("wpnum", b->number);
4962 uiout->text (" deleted because the program has left the block in\n"
4963 "which its expression is valid.\n");
4964 }
4965
4966 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
4967 b->commands = NULL;
4968 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
4969
4970 return WP_DELETED;
4971 }
4972 }
4973
4974 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
4975 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
4976 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
4977
4978 static int
4979 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
4980 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
4981 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4982 {
4983 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
4984
4985 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
4986 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
4987
4988 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
4989 }
4990
4991 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
4992 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
4993
4994 static void
4995 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
4996 {
4997 const struct bp_location *bl;
4998 struct watchpoint *b;
4999
5000 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5001 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5002 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5003 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5004 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5005
5006 {
5007 int must_check_value = 0;
5008
5009 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5010 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5011 watched value. */
5012 must_check_value = 1;
5013 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5014 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5015 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5016 this watchpoint. */
5017 must_check_value = 1;
5018 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5019 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5020 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5021 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5022 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5023 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5024 must_check_value = 1;
5025
5026 if (must_check_value)
5027 {
5028 wp_check_result e;
5029
5030 TRY
5031 {
5032 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5033 }
5034 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5035 {
5036 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5037 "Error evaluating expression "
5038 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5039 b->number);
5040
5041 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5042 {
5043 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5044 b->number);
5045 }
5046 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5047 e = WP_DELETED;
5048 }
5049 END_CATCH
5050
5051 switch (e)
5052 {
5053 case WP_DELETED:
5054 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5055 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5056 /* Stop. */
5057 break;
5058 case WP_IGNORE:
5059 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5060 bs->stop = 0;
5061 break;
5062 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5063 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5064 {
5065 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5066
5067 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5068 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5069 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5070 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5071 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5072 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5073 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5074 old value.
5075
5076 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5077 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5078 happen:
5079
5080 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5081 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5082 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5083 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5084
5085 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5086 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5087 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5088 watchpoint.
5089
5090 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5091 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5092 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5093 changes. This still gives false positives when
5094 the program writes the same value to memory as
5095 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5096 it for a read), but it's much better than
5097 nothing. */
5098
5099 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5100
5101 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5102 {
5103 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5104
5105 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5106 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5107 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5108 {
5109 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5110 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5111
5112 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5113 == watch_triggered_yes)
5114 {
5115 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5116 break;
5117 }
5118 }
5119 }
5120
5121 if (other_write_watchpoint
5122 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5123 {
5124 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5125 and the value changed since the last time we
5126 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5127 Ignore it. */
5128 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5129 bs->stop = 0;
5130 }
5131 }
5132 break;
5133 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5134 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5135 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5136 {
5137 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5138 the value hasn't changed. */
5139 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5140 bs->stop = 0;
5141 }
5142 /* Stop. */
5143 break;
5144 default:
5145 /* Can't happen. */
5146 break;
5147 }
5148 }
5149 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5150 {
5151 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5152 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5153 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5154 anything for this watchpoint. */
5155 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5156 bs->stop = 0;
5157 }
5158 }
5159 }
5160
5161 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5162 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5163 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5164 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5165
5166 static void
5167 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, thread_info *thread)
5168 {
5169 const struct bp_location *bl;
5170 struct breakpoint *b;
5171 /* Assume stop. */
5172 bool condition_result = true;
5173 struct expression *cond;
5174
5175 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5176
5177 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5178 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5179 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5180 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5181 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5182
5183 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5184 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5185 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5186
5187 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5188 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5189 {
5190 bs->stop = 0;
5191 return;
5192 }
5193
5194 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5195 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5196 thread/task. */
5197 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
5198 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
5199 {
5200 bs->stop = 0;
5201 return;
5202 }
5203
5204 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5205 implemented. */
5206 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5207
5208 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5209 {
5210 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5211
5212 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5213 }
5214 else
5215 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5216
5217 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5218 {
5219 int within_current_scope = 1;
5220 struct watchpoint * w;
5221
5222 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5223 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5224 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5225 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5226 function call. */
5227 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5228
5229 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5230 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5231 else
5232 w = NULL;
5233
5234 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5235 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5236 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5237 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5238 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5239 call site. */
5240 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5241 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5242 else
5243 {
5244 struct frame_info *frame;
5245
5246 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5247 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5248 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5249 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5250 really matter which instantiation of the function
5251 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5252 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5253 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5254 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5255 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5256 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5257 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5258 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5259 intuitive. */
5260 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5261 if (frame != NULL)
5262 select_frame (frame);
5263 else
5264 within_current_scope = 0;
5265 }
5266 if (within_current_scope)
5267 {
5268 TRY
5269 {
5270 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5271 }
5272 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
5273 {
5274 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5275 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5276 }
5277 END_CATCH
5278 }
5279 else
5280 {
5281 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5282 "in the current scope"));
5283 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5284 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5285 }
5286 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5287 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5288 }
5289
5290 if (cond && !condition_result)
5291 {
5292 bs->stop = 0;
5293 }
5294 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5295 {
5296 b->ignore_count--;
5297 bs->stop = 0;
5298 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5299 ++(b->hit_count);
5300 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5301 }
5302 }
5303
5304 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5305 on the current target. */
5306
5307 static int
5308 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5309 {
5310 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5311 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5312 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5313 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5314 }
5315
5316 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5317
5318 bpstat
5319 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5320 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5321 {
5322 struct breakpoint *b;
5323 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5324
5325 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5326 {
5327 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5328 continue;
5329
5330 for (bp_location *bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5331 {
5332 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5333 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5334 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5335 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5336 checked all locations already. */
5337 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5338 break;
5339
5340 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5341 continue;
5342
5343 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5344 continue;
5345
5346 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5347 matches. */
5348
5349 bpstat bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5350 explain stop. */
5351
5352 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5353 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5354 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5355 bs->stop = 1;
5356 bs->print = 1;
5357
5358 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5359 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5360 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5361 iteration. */
5362 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5363 {
5364 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5365
5366 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5367 }
5368 }
5369 }
5370
5371 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5372 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5373 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5374 {
5375 bp_location *loc;
5376
5377 for (int ix = 0;
5378 VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
5379 {
5380 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5381 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5382 {
5383 bpstat bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5384 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5385 bs->stop = 0;
5386 bs->print = 0;
5387 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5388 }
5389 }
5390 }
5391
5392 return bs_head;
5393 }
5394
5395 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5396
5397 bpstat
5398 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5399 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
5400 const struct target_waitstatus *ws,
5401 bpstat stop_chain)
5402 {
5403 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5404 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5405 bpstat bs_head = stop_chain;
5406 bpstat bs;
5407 int need_remove_insert;
5408 int removed_any;
5409
5410 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5411 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5412 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5413 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5414 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5415 inferior function calls. */
5416 if (bs_head == NULL)
5417 bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5418
5419 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5420 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5421 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5422 "catch unload". */
5423 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5424 {
5425 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5426 {
5427 handle_solib_event ();
5428 break;
5429 }
5430 }
5431
5432 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5433 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5434 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5435
5436 removed_any = 0;
5437
5438 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5439 {
5440 if (!bs->stop)
5441 continue;
5442
5443 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5444 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5445 if (bs->stop)
5446 {
5447 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
5448
5449 if (bs->stop)
5450 {
5451 ++(b->hit_count);
5452 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5453
5454 /* We will stop here. */
5455 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5456 {
5457 --(b->enable_count);
5458 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5459 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5460 removed_any = 1;
5461 }
5462 if (b->silent)
5463 bs->print = 0;
5464 bs->commands = b->commands;
5465 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5466 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5467 bs->print = 0;
5468
5469 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5470 }
5471
5472 }
5473
5474 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5475 print. */
5476 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5477 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5478 }
5479
5480 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5481 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5482 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5483 done later. */
5484 need_remove_insert = 0;
5485 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5486 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5487 if (!bs->stop
5488 && bs->breakpoint_at
5489 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5490 {
5491 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5492
5493 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5494 need_remove_insert = 1;
5495 }
5496
5497 if (need_remove_insert)
5498 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5499 else if (removed_any)
5500 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5501
5502 return bs_head;
5503 }
5504
5505 static void
5506 handle_jit_event (void)
5507 {
5508 struct frame_info *frame;
5509 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5510
5511 if (debug_infrun)
5512 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "handling bp_jit_event\n");
5513
5514 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5515 breakpoint_re_set. */
5516 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5517
5518 frame = get_current_frame ();
5519 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5520
5521 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5522
5523 target_terminal::inferior ();
5524 }
5525
5526 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5527
5528 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5529
5530 struct bpstat_what
5531 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5532 {
5533 struct bpstat_what retval;
5534 bpstat bs;
5535
5536 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5537 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5538 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5539
5540 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5541 {
5542 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5543 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5544 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5545 enum bptype bptype;
5546
5547 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5548 {
5549 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5550 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5551 bptype = bp_none;
5552 }
5553 else
5554 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5555
5556 switch (bptype)
5557 {
5558 case bp_none:
5559 break;
5560 case bp_breakpoint:
5561 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5562 case bp_single_step:
5563 case bp_until:
5564 case bp_finish:
5565 case bp_shlib_event:
5566 if (bs->stop)
5567 {
5568 if (bs->print)
5569 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5570 else
5571 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5572 }
5573 else
5574 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5575 break;
5576 case bp_watchpoint:
5577 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5578 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5579 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5580 if (bs->stop)
5581 {
5582 if (bs->print)
5583 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5584 else
5585 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5586 }
5587 else
5588 {
5589 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5590 This requires no further action. */
5591 }
5592 break;
5593 case bp_longjmp:
5594 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5595 case bp_exception:
5596 if (bs->stop)
5597 {
5598 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5599 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5600 }
5601 else
5602 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5603 break;
5604 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5605 case bp_exception_resume:
5606 if (bs->stop)
5607 {
5608 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5609 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5610 }
5611 else
5612 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5613 break;
5614 case bp_step_resume:
5615 if (bs->stop)
5616 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5617 else
5618 {
5619 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5620 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5621 }
5622 break;
5623 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5624 if (bs->stop)
5625 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5626 else
5627 {
5628 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5629 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5630 }
5631 break;
5632 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5633 case bp_thread_event:
5634 case bp_overlay_event:
5635 case bp_longjmp_master:
5636 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5637 case bp_exception_master:
5638 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5639 break;
5640 case bp_catchpoint:
5641 if (bs->stop)
5642 {
5643 if (bs->print)
5644 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5645 else
5646 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5647 }
5648 else
5649 {
5650 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5651 This requires no further action. */
5652 }
5653 break;
5654 case bp_jit_event:
5655 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5656 break;
5657 case bp_call_dummy:
5658 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5659 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5660 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5661 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5662 break;
5663 case bp_std_terminate:
5664 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5665 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5666 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5667 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5668 break;
5669 case bp_tracepoint:
5670 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5671 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5672 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5673 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5674 out already. */
5675 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5676 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5677 break;
5678 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5679 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5680 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5681 break;
5682 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5683 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5684 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5685 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5686 break;
5687
5688 case bp_dprintf:
5689 if (bs->stop)
5690 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5691 else
5692 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5693 break;
5694
5695 default:
5696 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5697 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5698 }
5699
5700 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5701 }
5702
5703 return retval;
5704 }
5705
5706 void
5707 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5708 {
5709 bpstat bs;
5710
5711 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5712 {
5713 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5714
5715 if (b == NULL)
5716 continue;
5717 switch (b->type)
5718 {
5719 case bp_jit_event:
5720 handle_jit_event ();
5721 break;
5722 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5723 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5724 break;
5725 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5726 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5727 break;
5728 }
5729 }
5730 }
5731
5732 /* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5733 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5734 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5735
5736 int
5737 bpstat_should_step (void)
5738 {
5739 struct breakpoint *b;
5740
5741 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5742 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5743 return 1;
5744 return 0;
5745 }
5746
5747 int
5748 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5749 {
5750 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5751 if (bs->stop)
5752 return 1;
5753
5754 return 0;
5755 }
5756
5757 \f
5758
5759 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5760 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5761 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5762
5763 static char *
5764 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5765 {
5766 static char wrap_indent[80];
5767 int i, total_width, width, align;
5768 const char *text;
5769
5770 total_width = 0;
5771 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5772 {
5773 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5774 {
5775 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5776 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5777 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5778
5779 return wrap_indent;
5780 }
5781
5782 total_width += width + 1;
5783 }
5784
5785 return NULL;
5786 }
5787
5788 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5789 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5790
5791 "host": Host evals condition.
5792 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5793 "target": Target evals condition.
5794 */
5795
5796 static const char *
5797 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5798 {
5799 struct bp_location *bl;
5800 char host_evals = 0;
5801 char target_evals = 0;
5802
5803 if (!b)
5804 return NULL;
5805
5806 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5807 return NULL;
5808
5809 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5810 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5811 return condition_evaluation_host;
5812
5813 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5814 {
5815 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5816 target_evals++;
5817 else
5818 host_evals++;
5819 }
5820
5821 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5822 return condition_evaluation_both;
5823 else if (target_evals)
5824 return condition_evaluation_target;
5825 else
5826 return condition_evaluation_host;
5827 }
5828
5829 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5830 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5831
5832 static const char *
5833 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5834 {
5835 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5836 return NULL;
5837
5838 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5839 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5840 return condition_evaluation_host;
5841
5842 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5843 return condition_evaluation_target;
5844 else
5845 return condition_evaluation_host;
5846 }
5847
5848 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5849
5850 static void
5851 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5852 struct bp_location *loc)
5853 {
5854 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5855
5856 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5857
5858 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5859 loc = NULL;
5860
5861 if (loc != NULL)
5862 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5863
5864 if (b->display_canonical)
5865 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5866 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5867 {
5868 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5869
5870 if (sym)
5871 {
5872 uiout->text ("in ");
5873 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
5874 uiout->text (" ");
5875 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5876 uiout->text ("at ");
5877 }
5878 uiout->field_string ("file",
5879 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
5880 uiout->text (":");
5881
5882 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5883 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5884
5885 uiout->field_int ("line", loc->line_number);
5886 }
5887 else if (loc)
5888 {
5889 string_file stb;
5890
5891 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5892 demangle, "");
5893 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5894 }
5895 else
5896 {
5897 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5898 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5899 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5900 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5901 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5902 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5903 {
5904 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5905 uiout->text (",");
5906 else
5907 uiout->text (" ");
5908 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5909 }
5910 }
5911
5912 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5913 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5914 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5915 {
5916 uiout->text (" (");
5917 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5918 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5919 uiout->text (")");
5920 }
5921 }
5922
5923 static const char *
5924 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5925 {
5926 struct ep_type_description
5927 {
5928 enum bptype type;
5929 const char *description;
5930 };
5931 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5932 {
5933 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5934 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5935 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5936 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5937 {bp_until, "until"},
5938 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5939 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5940 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5941 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5942 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5943 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5944 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5945 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5946 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5947 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5948 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5949 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5950 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5951 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5952 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5953 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5954 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5955 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5956 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5957 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5958 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5959 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
5960 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
5961 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
5962 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
5963 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
5964 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
5965 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
5966 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
5967 };
5968
5969 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
5970 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
5971 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5972 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
5973 (int) type);
5974
5975 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
5976 }
5977
5978 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
5979 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
5980
5981 static void
5982 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
5983 const char *field_name,
5984 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
5985 int mi_only)
5986 {
5987 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
5988
5989 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
5990 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
5991 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
5992 return;
5993
5994 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
5995
5996 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
5997 {
5998 if (is_mi)
5999 {
6000 char mi_group[10];
6001
6002 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
6003 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
6004 }
6005 else
6006 {
6007 if (i == 0)
6008 uiout->text (" inf ");
6009 else
6010 uiout->text (", ");
6011
6012 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
6013 }
6014 }
6015 }
6016
6017 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6018
6019 static void
6020 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6021 struct bp_location *loc,
6022 int loc_number,
6023 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6024 int allflag)
6025 {
6026 struct command_line *l;
6027 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6028
6029 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6030 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6031 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6032 struct value_print_options opts;
6033
6034 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6035
6036 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6037 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6038 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6039 if (loc == NULL
6040 && (b->loc != NULL
6041 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6042 header_of_multiple = 1;
6043 if (loc == NULL)
6044 loc = b->loc;
6045
6046 annotate_record ();
6047
6048 /* 1 */
6049 annotate_field (0);
6050 if (part_of_multiple)
6051 {
6052 char *formatted;
6053 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6054 uiout->field_string ("number", formatted);
6055 xfree (formatted);
6056 }
6057 else
6058 {
6059 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
6060 }
6061
6062 /* 2 */
6063 annotate_field (1);
6064 if (part_of_multiple)
6065 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6066 else
6067 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6068
6069 /* 3 */
6070 annotate_field (2);
6071 if (part_of_multiple)
6072 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6073 else
6074 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6075
6076
6077 /* 4 */
6078 annotate_field (3);
6079 if (part_of_multiple)
6080 uiout->field_string ("enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6081 else
6082 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6083 uiout->spaces (2);
6084
6085
6086 /* 5 and 6 */
6087 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6088 {
6089 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6090 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6091 make sure there's just one location. */
6092 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6093 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6094 }
6095 else
6096 switch (b->type)
6097 {
6098 case bp_none:
6099 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6100 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6101 break;
6102
6103 case bp_watchpoint:
6104 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6105 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6106 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6107 {
6108 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6109
6110 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6111 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6112 is relatively readable). */
6113 if (opts.addressprint)
6114 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6115 annotate_field (5);
6116 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6117 }
6118 break;
6119
6120 case bp_breakpoint:
6121 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6122 case bp_single_step:
6123 case bp_until:
6124 case bp_finish:
6125 case bp_longjmp:
6126 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6127 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6128 case bp_exception:
6129 case bp_exception_resume:
6130 case bp_step_resume:
6131 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6132 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6133 case bp_call_dummy:
6134 case bp_std_terminate:
6135 case bp_shlib_event:
6136 case bp_thread_event:
6137 case bp_overlay_event:
6138 case bp_longjmp_master:
6139 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6140 case bp_exception_master:
6141 case bp_tracepoint:
6142 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6143 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6144 case bp_dprintf:
6145 case bp_jit_event:
6146 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6147 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6148 if (opts.addressprint)
6149 {
6150 annotate_field (4);
6151 if (header_of_multiple)
6152 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6153 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6154 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>");
6155 else
6156 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6157 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6158 }
6159 annotate_field (5);
6160 if (!header_of_multiple)
6161 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6162 if (b->loc)
6163 *last_loc = b->loc;
6164 break;
6165 }
6166
6167
6168 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6169 {
6170 struct inferior *inf;
6171 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6172 int mi_only = 1;
6173
6174 ALL_INFERIORS (inf)
6175 {
6176 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6177 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6178 }
6179
6180 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6181 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6182 if (allflag
6183 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6184 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6185 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6186 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6187 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6188 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6189 mi_only = 0;
6190 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6191 }
6192
6193 if (!part_of_multiple)
6194 {
6195 if (b->thread != -1)
6196 {
6197 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6198 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6199 uiout->text (" thread ");
6200 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6201 }
6202 else if (b->task != 0)
6203 {
6204 uiout->text (" task ");
6205 uiout->field_int ("task", b->task);
6206 }
6207 }
6208
6209 uiout->text ("\n");
6210
6211 if (!part_of_multiple)
6212 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6213
6214 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6215 {
6216 annotate_field (6);
6217 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6218 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6219 the frame ID. */
6220 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6221 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6222 uiout->text ("\n");
6223 }
6224
6225 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6226 {
6227 annotate_field (7);
6228 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6229 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6230 else
6231 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6232 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6233
6234 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6235 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6236 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6237 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6238 == condition_evaluation_target)
6239 {
6240 uiout->text (" (");
6241 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
6242 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6243 uiout->text (" evals)");
6244 }
6245 uiout->text ("\n");
6246 }
6247
6248 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6249 {
6250 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6251 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6252 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6253 uiout->field_int ("thread", b->thread);
6254 else
6255 {
6256 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6257
6258 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6259 }
6260 uiout->text ("\n");
6261 }
6262
6263 if (!part_of_multiple)
6264 {
6265 if (b->hit_count)
6266 {
6267 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6268 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6269 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6270 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6271 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6272 else
6273 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6274 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6275 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6276 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6277 uiout->text (" time\n");
6278 else
6279 uiout->text (" times\n");
6280 }
6281 else
6282 {
6283 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6284 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6285 uiout->field_int ("times", b->hit_count);
6286 }
6287 }
6288
6289 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6290 {
6291 annotate_field (8);
6292 uiout->text ("\tignore next ");
6293 uiout->field_int ("ignore", b->ignore_count);
6294 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6295 }
6296
6297 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6298 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6299 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6300 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6301 {
6302 annotate_field (8);
6303 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6304 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6305 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6306 if (b->ignore_count)
6307 uiout->text ("additional ");
6308 else
6309 uiout->text ("next ");
6310 uiout->field_int ("enable", b->enable_count);
6311 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6312 }
6313
6314 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6315 {
6316 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6317
6318 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6319 {
6320 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6321 uiout->field_int ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6322 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6323 }
6324 }
6325
6326 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6327 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6328 {
6329 annotate_field (9);
6330 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6331 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6332 }
6333
6334 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6335 {
6336 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6337
6338 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6339 {
6340 annotate_field (10);
6341 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6342 uiout->field_int ("pass", t->pass_count);
6343 uiout->text (" \n");
6344 }
6345
6346 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6347 pending. */
6348 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6349 {
6350 annotate_field (11);
6351
6352 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6353 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6354 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6355 else
6356 {
6357 if (loc->inserted)
6358 uiout->text ("\t");
6359 else
6360 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6361 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6362 }
6363 }
6364 }
6365
6366 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6367 {
6368 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6369 {
6370 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6371
6372 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6373 }
6374 else if (b->location != NULL
6375 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6376 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6377 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6378 }
6379 }
6380
6381 static void
6382 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6383 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6384 int allflag)
6385 {
6386 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6387
6388 {
6389 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "bkpt");
6390
6391 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6392 }
6393
6394 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6395 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6396 locations, if any. */
6397 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6398 {
6399 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6400 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6401 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6402 situation.
6403
6404 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6405 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6406 if (b->loc
6407 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6408 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6409 {
6410 struct bp_location *loc;
6411 int n = 1;
6412
6413 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6414 {
6415 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6416 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6417 }
6418 }
6419 }
6420 }
6421
6422 static int
6423 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6424 {
6425 int print_address_bits = 0;
6426 struct bp_location *loc;
6427
6428 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6429 address to print. */
6430 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6431 return 0;
6432
6433 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6434 {
6435 int addr_bit;
6436
6437 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6438 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6439 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6440 }
6441
6442 return print_address_bits;
6443 }
6444
6445 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6446
6447 void
6448 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6449 {
6450 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6451 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6452 }
6453
6454 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6455 internal or momentary. */
6456
6457 int
6458 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6459 {
6460 return b->number > 0;
6461 }
6462
6463 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6464
6465 int
6466 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6467 {
6468 return b->loc == NULL;
6469 }
6470
6471 /* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6472 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6473 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6474 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6475 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6476 breakpoints listed. */
6477
6478 static int
6479 breakpoint_1 (const char *args, int allflag,
6480 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6481 {
6482 struct breakpoint *b;
6483 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6484 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6485 struct value_print_options opts;
6486 int print_address_bits = 0;
6487 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6488 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6489
6490 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6491
6492 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6493 required for address fields. */
6494 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6495 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6496 {
6497 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6498 if (filter && !filter (b))
6499 continue;
6500
6501 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6502 accept. Skip the others. */
6503 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6504 {
6505 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6506 continue;
6507 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6508 continue;
6509 }
6510
6511 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6512 {
6513 int addr_bit, type_len;
6514
6515 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6516 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6517 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6518
6519 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6520 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6521 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6522
6523 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6524 }
6525 }
6526
6527 {
6528 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6529 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6530 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6531 "BreakpointTable");
6532
6533 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6534 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6535 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6536 annotate_field (0);
6537 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6538 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6539 annotate_field (1);
6540 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6541 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6542 annotate_field (2);
6543 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6544 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6545 annotate_field (3);
6546 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6547 if (opts.addressprint)
6548 {
6549 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6550 annotate_field (4);
6551 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6552 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6553 else
6554 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6555 }
6556 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6557 annotate_field (5);
6558 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6559 uiout->table_body ();
6560 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6561 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6562
6563 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6564 {
6565 QUIT;
6566 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6567 if (filter && !filter (b))
6568 continue;
6569
6570 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6571 accept. Skip the others. */
6572
6573 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6574 {
6575 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6576 {
6577 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6578 continue;
6579 }
6580 else /* all others */
6581 {
6582 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6583 continue;
6584 }
6585 }
6586 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6587 allflag is set. */
6588 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6589 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6590 }
6591 }
6592
6593 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6594 {
6595 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6596 empty list. */
6597 if (!filter)
6598 {
6599 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6600 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6601 else
6602 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6603 args);
6604 }
6605 }
6606 else
6607 {
6608 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6609 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6610 }
6611
6612 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6613 there have been breakpoints? */
6614 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6615
6616 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6617 }
6618
6619 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6620 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6621
6622 static void
6623 default_collect_info (void)
6624 {
6625 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6626
6627 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6628 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6629 not wanted. */
6630 if (!*default_collect)
6631 return;
6632
6633 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6634 actions. */
6635 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6636 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6637 uiout->text (" \n");
6638 }
6639
6640 static void
6641 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6642 {
6643 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6644
6645 default_collect_info ();
6646 }
6647
6648 static void
6649 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6650 {
6651 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6652 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6653
6654 if (num_printed == 0)
6655 {
6656 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6657 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6658 else
6659 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6660 }
6661 }
6662
6663 static void
6664 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6665 {
6666 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6667
6668 default_collect_info ();
6669 }
6670
6671 static int
6672 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6673 struct program_space *pspace,
6674 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6675 {
6676 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6677
6678 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6679 {
6680 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6681 && bl->address == pc
6682 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6683 return 1;
6684 }
6685 return 0;
6686 }
6687
6688 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6689 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6690 address spaces. */
6691
6692 static void
6693 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6694 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6695 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6696 {
6697 int others = 0;
6698 struct breakpoint *b;
6699
6700 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6701 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6702 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6703 if (others > 0)
6704 {
6705 if (others == 1)
6706 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6707 else /* if (others == ???) */
6708 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6709 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6710 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6711 {
6712 others--;
6713 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6714 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6715 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6716 else if (b->thread != -1)
6717 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6718 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6719 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6720 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6721 ? " (disabled)"
6722 : ""),
6723 (others > 1) ? ","
6724 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6725 }
6726 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6727 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6728 printf_filtered (".\n");
6729 }
6730 }
6731 \f
6732
6733 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6734 BPT locations. For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members
6735 are irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to other
6736 addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6737
6738 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6739 always have a zero valued location address and we don't want to mark
6740 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6741 breakpoint location at address zero:
6742
6743 bp_watchpoint
6744 bp_catchpoint
6745
6746 */
6747
6748 static int
6749 breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6750 {
6751 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6752
6753 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6754 }
6755
6756 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6757 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6758
6759 static int
6760 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6761 struct bp_location *loc2)
6762 {
6763 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6764 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6765
6766 /* Both of them must exist. */
6767 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6768 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6769
6770 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6771 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6772 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6773 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6774 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6775 other watchpoint. */
6776 if ((w1->cond_exp
6777 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6778 loc1->length,
6779 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6780 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6781 || (w2->cond_exp
6782 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6783 loc2->length,
6784 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6785 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6786 return 0;
6787
6788 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6789 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6790 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6791 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6792 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6793 become hw_access locations later. */
6794 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6795 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6796 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6797 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6798 }
6799
6800 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6801
6802 int
6803 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6804 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6805 {
6806 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6807 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6808 && addr1 == addr2);
6809 }
6810
6811 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6812 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6813 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6814 space doesn't really matter. */
6815
6816 static int
6817 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6818 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6819 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6820 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6821 {
6822 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6823 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6824 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6825 }
6826
6827 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6828 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6829 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6830 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6831
6832 static int
6833 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6834 const address_space *aspace,
6835 CORE_ADDR addr)
6836 {
6837 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6838 aspace, addr)
6839 || (bl->length
6840 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6841 bl->address, bl->length,
6842 aspace, addr)));
6843 }
6844
6845 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6846 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6847 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6848 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6849 doesn't really matter. */
6850
6851 static int
6852 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6853 const address_space *aspace,
6854 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6855 {
6856 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6857 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6858 {
6859 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6860
6861 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6862 return 1;
6863 }
6864 return 0;
6865 }
6866
6867 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6868 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6869 true, otherwise returns false. */
6870
6871 static int
6872 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6873 struct bp_location *loc2)
6874 {
6875 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6876 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6877 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6878 different locations. */
6879 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6880 else
6881 return 0;
6882 }
6883
6884 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6885 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6886 represent the same location. */
6887
6888 static int
6889 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6890 struct bp_location *loc2)
6891 {
6892 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6893
6894 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6895 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6896 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6897
6898 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6899 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6900
6901 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6902 return 0;
6903 else if (hw_point1)
6904 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6905 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6906 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6907 else
6908 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
6909 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6910 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6911 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6912 }
6913
6914 static void
6915 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6916 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6917 {
6918 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6919 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6920 char astr1[64];
6921 char astr2[64];
6922
6923 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6924 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6925 if (have_bnum)
6926 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6927 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6928 else
6929 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6930 }
6931
6932 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6933 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6934 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6935 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6936
6937 static CORE_ADDR
6938 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6939 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6940 {
6941 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6942 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6943 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6944 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6945 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6946 {
6947 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6948 have their addresses modified. */
6949 return bpaddr;
6950 }
6951 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6952 {
6953 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6954 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6955 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6956 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6957 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6958 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6959 return bpaddr;
6960 }
6961 else
6962 {
6963 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
6964
6965 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
6966 {
6967 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
6968 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
6969 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
6970 }
6971
6972 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
6973
6974 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
6975 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
6976 is required. */
6977 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
6978 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
6979
6980 return adjusted_bpaddr;
6981 }
6982 }
6983
6984 bp_location::bp_location (const bp_location_ops *ops, breakpoint *owner)
6985 {
6986 bp_location *loc = this;
6987
6988 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
6989
6990 loc->ops = ops;
6991 loc->owner = owner;
6992 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
6993 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
6994 loc->enabled = 1;
6995
6996 switch (owner->type)
6997 {
6998 case bp_breakpoint:
6999 case bp_single_step:
7000 case bp_until:
7001 case bp_finish:
7002 case bp_longjmp:
7003 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7004 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7005 case bp_exception:
7006 case bp_exception_resume:
7007 case bp_step_resume:
7008 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7009 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7010 case bp_call_dummy:
7011 case bp_std_terminate:
7012 case bp_shlib_event:
7013 case bp_thread_event:
7014 case bp_overlay_event:
7015 case bp_jit_event:
7016 case bp_longjmp_master:
7017 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7018 case bp_exception_master:
7019 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7020 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7021 case bp_dprintf:
7022 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7023 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7024 break;
7025 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7026 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7027 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7028 break;
7029 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7030 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7031 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7032 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7033 break;
7034 case bp_watchpoint:
7035 case bp_catchpoint:
7036 case bp_tracepoint:
7037 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7038 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7039 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7040 break;
7041 default:
7042 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7043 }
7044
7045 loc->refc = 1;
7046 }
7047
7048 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7049
7050 static struct bp_location *
7051 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7052 {
7053 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7054 }
7055
7056 static void
7057 free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7058 {
7059 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7060 delete loc;
7061 }
7062
7063 /* Increment reference count. */
7064
7065 static void
7066 incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7067 {
7068 ++bl->refc;
7069 }
7070
7071 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7072 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7073
7074 static void
7075 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7076 {
7077 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7078
7079 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7080 free_bp_location (*blp);
7081 *blp = NULL;
7082 }
7083
7084 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7085
7086 static breakpoint *
7087 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7088 {
7089 struct breakpoint *b1;
7090 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7091
7092 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7093 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7094
7095 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7096 if (b1 == 0)
7097 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7098 else
7099 {
7100 while (b1->next)
7101 b1 = b1->next;
7102 b1->next = b.release ();
7103 }
7104
7105 return result;
7106 }
7107
7108 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7109
7110 static void
7111 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7112 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7113 enum bptype bptype,
7114 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7115 {
7116 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7117
7118 b->ops = ops;
7119 b->type = bptype;
7120 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7121 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7122 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7123 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7124 }
7125
7126 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7127 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7128
7129 static struct breakpoint *
7130 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7131 enum bptype bptype,
7132 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7133 {
7134 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7135
7136 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7137 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7138 }
7139
7140 /* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7141 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7142 enough. */
7143
7144 static void
7145 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7146 {
7147 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7148
7149 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7150 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7151 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7152 {
7153 const char *function_name;
7154
7155 if (loc->msymbol != NULL
7156 && (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7157 || MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc)
7158 && !explicit_loc)
7159 {
7160 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7161
7162 function_name = MSYMBOL_LINKAGE_NAME (loc->msymbol);
7163
7164 if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7165 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7166 {
7167 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7168 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7169 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7170 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7171 breakpoint. */
7172 loc->related_address = loc->address;
7173 }
7174 }
7175 else
7176 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
7177
7178 if (function_name)
7179 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7180 }
7181 }
7182
7183 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7184 struct gdbarch *
7185 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7186 {
7187 if (sal.section)
7188 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7189 if (sal.symtab)
7190 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7191
7192 return NULL;
7193 }
7194
7195 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7196 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7197 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7198
7199 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7200 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7201 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7202
7203 static void
7204 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7205 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7206 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7207 {
7208 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7209
7210 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7211
7212 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7213 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7214
7215 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7216 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7217 program space. */
7218 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7219 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7220 }
7221
7222 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7223 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7224 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7225 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7226 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7227 is also returned as the value of this function.
7228
7229 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7230 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7231 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7232 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7233 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7234 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7235 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7236
7237 struct breakpoint *
7238 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7239 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7240 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7241 {
7242 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7243
7244 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7245 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7246 }
7247
7248 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7249 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7250 initiated the operation. */
7251
7252 void
7253 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7254 {
7255 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7256 int thread = tp->global_num;
7257
7258 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7259 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7260 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7261 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7262 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7263 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7264 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7265 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7266 {
7267 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7268 struct breakpoint *clone;
7269
7270 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7271 after their removal. */
7272 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7273 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7274 clone->thread = thread;
7275 }
7276
7277 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7278 }
7279
7280 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7281 void
7282 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7283 {
7284 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7285
7286 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7287 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7288 {
7289 if (b->thread == thread)
7290 delete_breakpoint (b);
7291 }
7292 }
7293
7294 void
7295 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7296 {
7297 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7298
7299 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7300 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7301 {
7302 if (b->thread == thread)
7303 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7304 }
7305 }
7306
7307 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7308 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7309 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7310 breakpoints. */
7311
7312 struct breakpoint *
7313 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7314 {
7315 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7316
7317 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7318 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7319 {
7320 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7321
7322 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7323 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7324 1);
7325 new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
7326
7327 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7328
7329 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7330 if (retval == NULL)
7331 retval = new_b;
7332 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7333 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7334 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7335 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7336 }
7337
7338 return retval;
7339 }
7340
7341 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7342 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7343 stack.
7344
7345 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7346 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7347 frames. */
7348
7349 void
7350 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7351 {
7352 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7353
7354 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7355 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7356 {
7357 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7358
7359 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7360 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7361 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7362 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7363 continue;
7364
7365 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
7366
7367 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7368 {
7369 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7370 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7371 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7372 }
7373 delete_breakpoint (b);
7374 }
7375 }
7376
7377 void
7378 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7379 {
7380 struct breakpoint *b;
7381
7382 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7383 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7384 {
7385 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7386 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7387 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7388 }
7389 }
7390
7391 void
7392 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7393 {
7394 struct breakpoint *b;
7395
7396 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7397 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7398 {
7399 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7400 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7401 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7402 }
7403 }
7404
7405 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7406 master breakpoint. */
7407 void
7408 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7409 {
7410 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7411
7412 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7413 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7414 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7415 {
7416 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7417 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7418 }
7419 }
7420
7421 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7422 void
7423 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7424 {
7425 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7426
7427 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7428 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7429 delete_breakpoint (b);
7430 }
7431
7432 struct breakpoint *
7433 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7434 {
7435 struct breakpoint *b;
7436
7437 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7438 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7439
7440 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7441 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7442 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7443
7444 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7445
7446 return b;
7447 }
7448
7449 struct lang_and_radix
7450 {
7451 enum language lang;
7452 int radix;
7453 };
7454
7455 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7456
7457 struct breakpoint *
7458 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7459 {
7460 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7461 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7462 }
7463
7464 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7465
7466 void
7467 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7468 {
7469 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7470
7471 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7472 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7473 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7474 delete_breakpoint (b);
7475 }
7476
7477 void
7478 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7479 {
7480 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7481
7482 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7483 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7484 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7485 delete_breakpoint (b);
7486 }
7487
7488 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7489
7490 void
7491 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7492 {
7493 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7494
7495 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7496 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7497 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7498 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7499 }
7500
7501 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7502 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7503 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7504
7505 static struct breakpoint *
7506 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7507 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7508 {
7509 struct breakpoint *b;
7510
7511 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7512 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7513 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7514 return b;
7515 }
7516
7517 struct breakpoint *
7518 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7519 {
7520 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7521 }
7522
7523 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7524
7525 struct breakpoint *
7526 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7527 {
7528 struct breakpoint *b;
7529
7530 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7531 locations. */
7532 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7533 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7534 {
7535 delete_breakpoint (b);
7536 return NULL;
7537 }
7538 return b;
7539 }
7540
7541 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7542 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7543
7544 void
7545 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7546 {
7547 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7548
7549 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7550 {
7551 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7552 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7553
7554 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7555 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7556 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7557 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7558 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7559 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7560 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7561 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7562 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7563 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7564 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7565 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7566 )
7567 {
7568 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7569 }
7570 }
7571 }
7572
7573 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7574 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7575 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7576
7577 static void
7578 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7579 {
7580 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7581 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7582
7583 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7584 {
7585 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7586 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7587
7588 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7589 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7590 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7591 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7592 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7593 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7594 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7595 || is_tracepoint (b))
7596 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7597 {
7598 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7599 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7600 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7601 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7602 loc->inserted = 0;
7603
7604 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7605 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7606
7607 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7608 {
7609 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7610 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7611 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7612 solib->so_name);
7613 }
7614 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7615 }
7616 }
7617 }
7618
7619 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7620 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7621 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7622
7623 static void
7624 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7625 {
7626 struct breakpoint *b;
7627
7628 if (objfile == NULL)
7629 return;
7630
7631 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7632 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7633 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7634 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7635 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7636 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7637 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7638 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7639 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7640 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7641 main objfile). */
7642 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7643 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7644 return;
7645
7646 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7647 {
7648 struct bp_location *loc;
7649 int bp_modified = 0;
7650
7651 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7652 continue;
7653
7654 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7655 {
7656 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7657
7658 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7659 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7660 continue;
7661
7662 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7663 continue;
7664
7665 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7666 continue;
7667
7668 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7669 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7670 continue;
7671
7672 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7673 {
7674 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7675 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7676 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7677 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7678 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7679 unmapped. */
7680
7681 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7682
7683 bp_modified = 1;
7684 }
7685 }
7686
7687 if (bp_modified)
7688 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7689 }
7690 }
7691
7692 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7693
7694 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7695 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7696 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7697
7698 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7699 {
7700 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7701 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7702 catchpoint has triggered. */
7703 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7704 };
7705
7706 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7707 catchpoints. */
7708
7709 static int
7710 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7711 {
7712 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7713 }
7714
7715 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7716 catchpoints. */
7717
7718 static int
7719 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7720 {
7721 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7722 }
7723
7724 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7725 catchpoints. */
7726
7727 static int
7728 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7729 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7730 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7731 {
7732 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7733
7734 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7735 return 0;
7736
7737 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7738 return 1;
7739 }
7740
7741 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7742 catchpoints. */
7743
7744 static enum print_stop_action
7745 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7746 {
7747 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7748 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7749 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7750
7751 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7752 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7753 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7754 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7755 else
7756 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7757 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7758 {
7759 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7760 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7761 }
7762 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7763 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7764 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7765 uiout->text ("), ");
7766 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7767 }
7768
7769 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7770 catchpoints. */
7771
7772 static void
7773 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7774 {
7775 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7776 struct value_print_options opts;
7777 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7778
7779 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7780
7781 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7782 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7783 readable). */
7784 if (opts.addressprint)
7785 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7786 annotate_field (5);
7787 uiout->text ("fork");
7788 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7789 {
7790 uiout->text (", process ");
7791 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7792 uiout->spaces (1);
7793 }
7794
7795 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7796 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7797 }
7798
7799 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7800 catchpoints. */
7801
7802 static void
7803 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7804 {
7805 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7806 }
7807
7808 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7809 catchpoints. */
7810
7811 static void
7812 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7813 {
7814 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7815 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7816 }
7817
7818 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7819
7820 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7821
7822 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7823 catchpoints. */
7824
7825 static int
7826 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7827 {
7828 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7829 }
7830
7831 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7832 catchpoints. */
7833
7834 static int
7835 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7836 {
7837 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7838 }
7839
7840 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7841 catchpoints. */
7842
7843 static int
7844 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7845 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7846 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7847 {
7848 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7849
7850 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7851 return 0;
7852
7853 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7854 return 1;
7855 }
7856
7857 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7858 catchpoints. */
7859
7860 static enum print_stop_action
7861 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7862 {
7863 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7864 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7865 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7866
7867 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7868 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7869 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7870 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7871 else
7872 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7873 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7874 {
7875 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7876 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7877 }
7878 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
7879 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7880 uiout->field_int ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7881 uiout->text ("), ");
7882 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7883 }
7884
7885 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7886 catchpoints. */
7887
7888 static void
7889 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7890 {
7891 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7892 struct value_print_options opts;
7893 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7894
7895 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7896 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7897 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7898 readable). */
7899 if (opts.addressprint)
7900 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7901 annotate_field (5);
7902 uiout->text ("vfork");
7903 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7904 {
7905 uiout->text (", process ");
7906 uiout->field_int ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7907 uiout->spaces (1);
7908 }
7909
7910 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7911 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7912 }
7913
7914 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7915 catchpoints. */
7916
7917 static void
7918 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7919 {
7920 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7921 }
7922
7923 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7924 catchpoints. */
7925
7926 static void
7927 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7928 {
7929 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7930 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7931 }
7932
7933 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7934
7935 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7936
7937 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7938 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7939 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7940
7941 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7942 {
7943 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
7944
7945 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7946 unsigned char is_load;
7947
7948 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7949 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7950 char *regex;
7951 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
7952 };
7953
7954 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
7955 {
7956 xfree (this->regex);
7957 }
7958
7959 static int
7960 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
7961 {
7962 return 0;
7963 }
7964
7965 static int
7966 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7967 {
7968 return 0;
7969 }
7970
7971 static int
7972 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
7973 const address_space *aspace,
7974 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7975 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7976 {
7977 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7978 struct breakpoint *other;
7979
7980 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
7981 return 1;
7982
7983 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
7984 {
7985 struct bp_location *other_bl;
7986
7987 if (other == bl->owner)
7988 continue;
7989
7990 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
7991 continue;
7992
7993 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
7994 continue;
7995
7996 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
7997 {
7998 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
7999 return 1;
8000 }
8001 }
8002
8003 return 0;
8004 }
8005
8006 static void
8007 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8008 {
8009 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8010 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8011
8012 if (self->is_load)
8013 {
8014 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
8015 {
8016 if (!self->regex
8017 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8018 return;
8019 }
8020 }
8021 else
8022 {
8023 for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
8024 {
8025 if (!self->regex
8026 || self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8027 return;
8028 }
8029 }
8030
8031 bs->stop = 0;
8032 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8033 }
8034
8035 static enum print_stop_action
8036 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8037 {
8038 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8039 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8040
8041 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8042 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8043 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8044 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8045 else
8046 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8047 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8048 uiout->text ("\n");
8049 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8050 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8051 print_solib_event (1);
8052 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8053 }
8054
8055 static void
8056 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8057 {
8058 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8059 struct value_print_options opts;
8060 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8061 char *msg;
8062
8063 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8064 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8065 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8066 readable). */
8067 if (opts.addressprint)
8068 {
8069 annotate_field (4);
8070 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8071 }
8072
8073 annotate_field (5);
8074 if (self->is_load)
8075 {
8076 if (self->regex)
8077 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8078 else
8079 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
8080 }
8081 else
8082 {
8083 if (self->regex)
8084 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8085 else
8086 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
8087 }
8088 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8089 xfree (msg);
8090
8091 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8092 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8093 }
8094
8095 static void
8096 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8097 {
8098 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8099
8100 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8101 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8102 }
8103
8104 static void
8105 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8106 {
8107 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8108
8109 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8110 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8111 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8112 if (self->regex)
8113 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8114 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8115 }
8116
8117 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8118
8119 /* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8120 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8121 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8122 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8123 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8124 created in an enabled state. */
8125
8126 void
8127 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8128 {
8129 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8130
8131 if (!arg)
8132 arg = "";
8133 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8134
8135 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8136
8137 if (*arg != '\0')
8138 {
8139 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8140 _("Invalid regexp")));
8141 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8142 }
8143
8144 c->is_load = is_load;
8145 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8146 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8147
8148 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8149
8150 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8151 }
8152
8153 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8154 "catch unload". */
8155
8156 static void
8157 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8158 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8159 {
8160 int tempflag;
8161 const int enabled = 1;
8162
8163 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8164
8165 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8166 }
8167
8168 static void
8169 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8170 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8171 {
8172 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8173 }
8174
8175 static void
8176 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8177 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8178 {
8179 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8180 }
8181
8182 /* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8183 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8184 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8185 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8186
8187 void
8188 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8189 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8190 const char *cond_string,
8191 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8192 {
8193 symtab_and_line sal;
8194 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8195
8196 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8197
8198 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8199 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8200 }
8201
8202 void
8203 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8204 {
8205 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8206 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8207 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8208 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8209 if (!internal)
8210 mention (b);
8211 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
8212
8213 if (update_gll)
8214 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8215 }
8216
8217 static void
8218 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8219 int tempflag, const char *cond_string,
8220 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8221 {
8222 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8223
8224 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8225
8226 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8227
8228 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8229 }
8230
8231 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8232
8233 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8234 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8235 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8236
8237 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8238 {
8239 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8240
8241 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8242 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8243 triggered. */
8244 char *exec_pathname;
8245 };
8246
8247 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8248
8249 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8250 {
8251 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8252 }
8253
8254 static int
8255 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8256 {
8257 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8258 }
8259
8260 static int
8261 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8262 {
8263 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8264 }
8265
8266 static int
8267 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8268 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8269 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8270 {
8271 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8272
8273 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8274 return 0;
8275
8276 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8277 return 1;
8278 }
8279
8280 static enum print_stop_action
8281 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8282 {
8283 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8284 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8285 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8286
8287 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8288 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8289 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8290 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8291 else
8292 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8293 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8294 {
8295 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8296 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8297 }
8298 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
8299 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8300 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8301 uiout->text ("), ");
8302
8303 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8304 }
8305
8306 static void
8307 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8308 {
8309 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8310 struct value_print_options opts;
8311 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8312
8313 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8314
8315 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8316 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8317 is relatively readable). */
8318 if (opts.addressprint)
8319 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8320 annotate_field (5);
8321 uiout->text ("exec");
8322 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8323 {
8324 uiout->text (", program \"");
8325 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8326 uiout->text ("\" ");
8327 }
8328
8329 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8330 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8331 }
8332
8333 static void
8334 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8335 {
8336 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8337 }
8338
8339 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8340 catchpoints. */
8341
8342 static void
8343 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8344 {
8345 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8346 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8347 }
8348
8349 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8350
8351 static int
8352 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8353 {
8354 int i = 0;
8355 struct breakpoint *b;
8356 struct bp_location *bl;
8357
8358 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8359 {
8360 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8361 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8362 {
8363 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8364 one register. */
8365 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8366 }
8367 }
8368
8369 return i;
8370 }
8371
8372 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8373 watchpoint. */
8374
8375 static int
8376 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8377 {
8378 int i = 0;
8379 struct bp_location *bl;
8380
8381 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8382 return 0;
8383
8384 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8385 {
8386 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8387 one register. */
8388 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8389 }
8390
8391 return i;
8392 }
8393
8394 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8395 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8396 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8397 types _not_ TYPE. */
8398
8399 static int
8400 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8401 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8402 {
8403 int i = 0;
8404 struct breakpoint *b;
8405
8406 *other_type_used = 0;
8407 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8408 {
8409 if (b == except)
8410 continue;
8411 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8412 continue;
8413
8414 if (b->type == type)
8415 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8416 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8417 *other_type_used = 1;
8418 }
8419
8420 return i;
8421 }
8422
8423 void
8424 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8425 {
8426 struct breakpoint *b;
8427
8428 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8429 {
8430 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8431 {
8432 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8433 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8434 }
8435 }
8436 }
8437
8438 void
8439 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8440 {
8441 struct breakpoint *b;
8442
8443 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8444 {
8445 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8446 {
8447 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8448 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8449 }
8450 }
8451 }
8452
8453 void
8454 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8455 {
8456 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8457 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8458 }
8459
8460 void
8461 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8462 {
8463 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8464 breakpoint_re_set ();
8465 }
8466
8467 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8468 locations. */
8469
8470 static struct breakpoint *
8471 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8472 {
8473 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8474
8475 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8476 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8477
8478 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8479 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8480
8481 b->thread = thread;
8482 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8483
8484 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8485 }
8486
8487 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8488 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8489 frame. */
8490
8491 breakpoint_up
8492 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8493 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8494 {
8495 struct breakpoint *b;
8496
8497 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8498 tail-called one. */
8499 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8500
8501 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8502 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8503 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8504 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8505
8506 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
8507
8508 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8509
8510 return breakpoint_up (b);
8511 }
8512
8513 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8514 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8515 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8516
8517 static struct breakpoint *
8518 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8519 enum bptype type,
8520 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8521 int loc_enabled)
8522 {
8523 struct breakpoint *copy;
8524
8525 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8526 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8527 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
8528
8529 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8530 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8531 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8532 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8533 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8534 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8535 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8536 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8537 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8538 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8539 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8540 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8541
8542 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8543 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8544 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8545
8546 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8547 return copy;
8548 }
8549
8550 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8551 ORIG is NULL. */
8552
8553 struct breakpoint *
8554 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8555 {
8556 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8557 if (orig == NULL)
8558 return NULL;
8559
8560 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8561 }
8562
8563 breakpoint_up
8564 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8565 enum bptype type)
8566 {
8567 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8568
8569 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8570 sal.pc = pc;
8571 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8572 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8573
8574 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8575 }
8576 \f
8577
8578 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8579
8580 static void
8581 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8582 {
8583 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8584 current_uiout->text ("\n");
8585 }
8586 \f
8587
8588 static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8589
8590 static struct bp_location *
8591 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8592 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8593 {
8594 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8595 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8596 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8597
8598 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8599 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8600
8601 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8602 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8603 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8604 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8605 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8606 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8607 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8608 sal->pc, b->type);
8609
8610 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8611 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8612 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8613 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8614 ;
8615 loc->next = *tmp;
8616 *tmp = loc;
8617
8618 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8619 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8620 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8621 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8622 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8623 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8624 loc->section = sal->section;
8625 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8626 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8627 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8628 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8629 loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
8630 loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
8631
8632 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
8633 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
8634
8635 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8636 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8637 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8638 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8639 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8640 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8641 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8642 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8643 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8644 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8645 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8646 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8647 instruction.) */
8648 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8649 loc->permanent = 1;
8650
8651 return loc;
8652 }
8653 \f
8654
8655 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8656
8657 int
8658 program_breakpoint_here_p (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
8659 {
8660 int len;
8661 CORE_ADDR addr;
8662 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
8663 gdb_byte *target_mem;
8664
8665 addr = address;
8666 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &len);
8667
8668 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
8669 if (bpoint == NULL)
8670 return 0;
8671
8672 target_mem = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
8673
8674 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
8675 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
8676 breakpoints they are permanent. */
8677 scoped_restore restore_memory
8678 = make_scoped_restore_show_memory_breakpoints (0);
8679
8680 if (target_read_memory (address, target_mem, len) == 0
8681 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
8682 return 1;
8683
8684 return 0;
8685 }
8686
8687 /* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8688 return 0 otherwise. */
8689
8690 static int
8691 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8692 {
8693 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8694
8695 /* If we have a catchpoint or a watchpoint, just return 0. We should not
8696 attempt to read from the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types
8697 point to. program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8698 memory. */
8699 if (!breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (loc->owner))
8700 return 0;
8701
8702 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8703 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8704 return program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8705 }
8706
8707 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8708 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8709
8710 static void
8711 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8712 {
8713 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8714 char *printf_line = NULL;
8715
8716 if (!dprintf_args)
8717 return;
8718
8719 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8720
8721 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8722 insist on it. */
8723 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8724 ++dprintf_args;
8725 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8726
8727 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8728 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8729
8730 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8731 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8732 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8733 {
8734 if (!dprintf_function)
8735 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8736
8737 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8738 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8739 dprintf_function,
8740 dprintf_channel,
8741 dprintf_args);
8742 else
8743 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8744 dprintf_function,
8745 dprintf_args);
8746 }
8747 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8748 {
8749 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8750 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8751 else
8752 {
8753 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8754 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8755 }
8756 }
8757 else
8758 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8759 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8760
8761 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8762
8763 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8764 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
8765 = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line);
8766 breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
8767 command_lines_deleter ()));
8768 }
8769
8770 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8771 current style settings. */
8772
8773 static void
8774 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8775 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8776 {
8777 struct breakpoint *b;
8778
8779 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8780 {
8781 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8782 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8783 }
8784 }
8785
8786 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8787 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8788 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8789 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8790
8791 static void
8792 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8793 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8794 event_location_up &&location,
8795 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8796 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8797 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8798 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8799 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8800 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8801 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8802 int display_canonical)
8803 {
8804 int i;
8805
8806 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8807 {
8808 int target_resources_ok;
8809
8810 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8811 target_resources_ok =
8812 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8813 i + 1, 0);
8814 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8815 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8816 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8817 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8818 }
8819
8820 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8821
8822 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8823 {
8824 struct bp_location *loc;
8825
8826 if (from_tty)
8827 {
8828 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8829 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8830 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8831
8832 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8833 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8834 }
8835
8836 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8837 {
8838 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8839 b->thread = thread;
8840 b->task = task;
8841
8842 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8843 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8844 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8845 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8846 b->disposition = disposition;
8847
8848 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8849 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8850
8851 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8852 {
8853 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8854 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8855
8856 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8857 {
8858 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8859 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8860 const char *p
8861 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8862 const char *endp;
8863
8864 p = skip_spaces (p);
8865
8866 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8867
8868 t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
8869
8870 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8871 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8872 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8873 }
8874 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8875 {
8876 t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
8877
8878 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8879 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8880 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8881 }
8882 else
8883 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8884 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8885 }
8886
8887 loc = b->loc;
8888 }
8889 else
8890 {
8891 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8892 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8893 loc->inserted = 1;
8894 }
8895
8896 if (b->cond_string)
8897 {
8898 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
8899
8900 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
8901 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
8902 if (*arg)
8903 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
8904 }
8905
8906 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8907 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8908 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8909 {
8910 if (b->extra_string)
8911 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8912 else
8913 error (_("Format string required"));
8914 }
8915 else if (b->extra_string)
8916 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8917 }
8918
8919 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8920 if (location != NULL)
8921 b->location = std::move (location);
8922 else
8923 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8924 b->filter = filter.release ();
8925 }
8926
8927 static void
8928 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8929 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8930 event_location_up &&location,
8931 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8932 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8933 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8934 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8935 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8936 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8937 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8938 int display_canonical)
8939 {
8940 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
8941
8942 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
8943 sals, std::move (location),
8944 std::move (filter),
8945 std::move (cond_string),
8946 std::move (extra_string),
8947 type, disposition,
8948 thread, task, ignore_count,
8949 ops, from_tty,
8950 enabled, internal, flags,
8951 display_canonical);
8952
8953 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
8954 }
8955
8956 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8957 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8958 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8959 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8960 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8961 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8962 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
8963 we take just a single condition string.
8964
8965 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
8966 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
8967 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
8968 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
8969 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
8970
8971 static void
8972 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8973 struct linespec_result *canonical,
8974 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8975 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8976 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8977 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8978 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8979 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
8980 {
8981 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
8982 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
8983
8984 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
8985 {
8986 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
8987 'break', without arguments. */
8988 event_location_up location
8989 = (canonical->location != NULL
8990 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
8991 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
8992 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
8993
8994 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
8995 std::move (location),
8996 std::move (filter_string),
8997 std::move (cond_string),
8998 std::move (extra_string),
8999 type, disposition,
9000 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9001 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9002 canonical->special_display);
9003 }
9004 }
9005
9006 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9007 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9008 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
9009 linespec locations).
9010
9011 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9012 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9013
9014 static void
9015 parse_breakpoint_sals (const struct event_location *location,
9016 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9017 {
9018 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9019
9020 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9021 {
9022 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9023
9024 if (spec == NULL)
9025 {
9026 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9027 breakpoint address. */
9028 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9029 {
9030 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9031 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9032 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9033 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9034 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9035 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
9036 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
9037
9038 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9039
9040 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9041 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9042 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9043 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9044 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9045 sal.pc = pc;
9046 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9047
9048 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9049 lsal.sals = {sal};
9050 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9051
9052 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
9053 return;
9054 }
9055 else
9056 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9057 }
9058 }
9059
9060 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9061 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9062 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9063 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9064
9065 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9066 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9067 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9068 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9069 {
9070 const char *spec = NULL;
9071
9072 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9073 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9074
9075 if (!cursal.symtab
9076 || (spec != NULL
9077 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
9078 && spec[1] != '['))
9079 {
9080 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9081 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9082 get_last_displayed_line (),
9083 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9084 return;
9085 }
9086 }
9087
9088 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9089 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9090 }
9091
9092
9093 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9094 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9095
9096 static void
9097 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
9098 {
9099 for (auto &sal : sals)
9100 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
9101 }
9102
9103 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9104 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9105 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9106 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9107 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9108 it, etc. */
9109
9110 static void
9111 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9112 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9113 {
9114 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9115 {
9116 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9117
9118 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9119 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9120 associated with SAL. */
9121 if (sarch == NULL)
9122 sarch = gdbarch;
9123 std::string msg;
9124 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
9125 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9126 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
9127 }
9128 }
9129
9130 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9131 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9132 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9133 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9134 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9135 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9136
9137 static void
9138 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9139 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9140 char **rest)
9141 {
9142 *cond_string = NULL;
9143 *thread = -1;
9144 *task = 0;
9145 *rest = NULL;
9146
9147 while (tok && *tok)
9148 {
9149 const char *end_tok;
9150 int toklen;
9151 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9152 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9153
9154 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9155
9156 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9157 {
9158 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9159 return;
9160 }
9161
9162 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9163
9164 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9165
9166 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9167 {
9168 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9169 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9170 cond_end = tok;
9171 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9172 }
9173 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9174 {
9175 const char *tmptok;
9176 struct thread_info *thr;
9177
9178 tok = end_tok + 1;
9179 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9180 if (tok == tmptok)
9181 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9182 *thread = thr->global_num;
9183 tok = tmptok;
9184 }
9185 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9186 {
9187 char *tmptok;
9188
9189 tok = end_tok + 1;
9190 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9191 if (tok == tmptok)
9192 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9193 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9194 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9195 tok = tmptok;
9196 }
9197 else if (rest)
9198 {
9199 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9200 return;
9201 }
9202 else
9203 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9204 }
9205 }
9206
9207 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9208
9209 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9210 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9211 {
9212 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9213 const char *endp;
9214
9215 p = skip_spaces (p);
9216
9217 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9218
9219 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9220
9221 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
9222 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9223 if (markers.empty ())
9224 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9225 marker_str.c_str ());
9226
9227 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9228 sals.reserve (markers.size ());
9229
9230 for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
9231 {
9232 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
9233 sal.pc = marker.address;
9234 sals.push_back (sal);
9235 }
9236
9237 *arg_p = endp;
9238 return sals;
9239 }
9240
9241 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9242
9243 int
9244 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9245 const struct event_location *location,
9246 const char *cond_string,
9247 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9248 int parse_extra,
9249 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9250 int ignore_count,
9251 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9252 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9253 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9254 unsigned flags)
9255 {
9256 struct linespec_result canonical;
9257 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9258 int pending = 0;
9259 int task = 0;
9260 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9261
9262 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9263
9264 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9265 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9266 extra_string = NULL;
9267
9268 TRY
9269 {
9270 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9271 }
9272 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
9273 {
9274 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9275 value. */
9276 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9277 {
9278 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9279 error. */
9280
9281 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9282 throw_exception (e);
9283
9284 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9285
9286 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9287 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9288 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9289 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9290 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9291 return 0;
9292
9293 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9294 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9295 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9296 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9297 pending = 1;
9298 }
9299 else
9300 throw_exception (e);
9301 }
9302 END_CATCH
9303
9304 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9305 return 0;
9306
9307 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
9308 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
9309 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
9310 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
9311 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
9312
9313 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9314 are ok for the target. */
9315 if (!pending)
9316 {
9317 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9318 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9319 }
9320
9321 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9322 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9323 {
9324 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9325 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9326 }
9327
9328 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9329 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9330 breakpoint. */
9331 if (!pending)
9332 {
9333 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9334 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9335
9336 if (parse_extra)
9337 {
9338 char *rest;
9339 char *cond;
9340
9341 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9342
9343 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
9344 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
9345 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
9346 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
9347
9348 find_condition_and_thread (extra_string, lsal.sals[0].pc,
9349 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9350 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9351 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9352 }
9353 else
9354 {
9355 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9356 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9357 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9358
9359 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9360 if (cond_string)
9361 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9362 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9363 if (extra_string)
9364 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9365 }
9366
9367 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9368 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9369 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9370 type_wanted,
9371 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9372 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9373 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9374 }
9375 else
9376 {
9377 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9378
9379 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9380 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9381
9382 if (parse_extra)
9383 b->cond_string = NULL;
9384 else
9385 {
9386 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9387 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9388 b->thread = thread;
9389 }
9390
9391 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9392 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9393 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9394 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9395 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9396 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9397 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9398 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9399 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9400
9401 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9402 }
9403
9404 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9405 {
9406 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9407 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9408 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9409 }
9410
9411 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
9412 breakpoint. */
9413 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
9414
9415 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
9416 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9417
9418 return 1;
9419 }
9420
9421 /* Set a breakpoint.
9422 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9423 condition, and thread.
9424 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9425 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9426 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9427
9428 static void
9429 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9430 {
9431 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9432 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9433 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9434 : bp_breakpoint);
9435 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
9436
9437 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9438
9439 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
9440 if (location != NULL
9441 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
9442 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9443 else
9444 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9445
9446 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9447 location.get (),
9448 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9449 tempflag, type_wanted,
9450 0 /* Ignore count */,
9451 pending_break_support,
9452 ops,
9453 from_tty,
9454 1 /* enabled */,
9455 0 /* internal */,
9456 0);
9457 }
9458
9459 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9460
9461 void
9462 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9463 {
9464 CORE_ADDR pc;
9465
9466 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9467 {
9468 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9469 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9470 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9471 sal->pc = pc;
9472
9473 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9474 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9475 if (sal->explicit_line)
9476 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9477 }
9478
9479 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9480 {
9481 const struct blockvector *bv;
9482 const struct block *b;
9483 struct symbol *sym;
9484
9485 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9486 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9487 if (bv != NULL)
9488 {
9489 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9490 if (sym != NULL)
9491 {
9492 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9493 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
9494 sym);
9495 }
9496 else
9497 {
9498 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9499 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9500 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9501 happen in assembly source). */
9502
9503 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9504 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9505
9506 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9507 if (msym.minsym)
9508 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
9509 }
9510 }
9511 }
9512 }
9513
9514 void
9515 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9516 {
9517 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9518 }
9519
9520 void
9521 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9522 {
9523 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9524 }
9525
9526 static void
9527 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9528 {
9529 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9530 }
9531
9532 static void
9533 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9534 {
9535 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9536 }
9537
9538 static void
9539 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9540 {
9541 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9542 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9543 stop at <line>\n"));
9544 }
9545
9546 static void
9547 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9548 {
9549 int badInput = 0;
9550
9551 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
9552 badInput = 1;
9553 else if (*arg != '*')
9554 {
9555 const char *argptr = arg;
9556 int hasColon = 0;
9557
9558 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9559 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9560 function/method name. */
9561 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9562 {
9563 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9564 argptr++;
9565 }
9566
9567 if (hasColon)
9568 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9569 else
9570 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9571 }
9572
9573 if (badInput)
9574 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9575 else
9576 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9577 }
9578
9579 static void
9580 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9581 {
9582 int badInput = 0;
9583
9584 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9585 badInput = 1;
9586 else
9587 {
9588 const char *argptr = arg;
9589 int hasColon = 0;
9590
9591 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9592 it is probably a line number. */
9593 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9594 {
9595 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9596 argptr++;
9597 }
9598
9599 if (hasColon)
9600 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9601 else
9602 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9603 }
9604
9605 if (badInput)
9606 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
9607 else
9608 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9609 }
9610
9611 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9612 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9613 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9614 line. */
9615
9616 static void
9617 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9618 {
9619 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9620
9621 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9622 the next character must be ','. */
9623 if (arg != NULL)
9624 {
9625 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9626 error (_("Format string required"));
9627 else
9628 {
9629 /* Skip the comma. */
9630 ++arg;
9631 }
9632 }
9633
9634 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9635 location.get (),
9636 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
9637 0, bp_dprintf,
9638 0 /* Ignore count */,
9639 pending_break_support,
9640 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9641 from_tty,
9642 1 /* enabled */,
9643 0 /* internal */,
9644 0);
9645 }
9646
9647 static void
9648 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9649 {
9650 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9651 }
9652
9653 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9654 ranged breakpoints. */
9655
9656 static int
9657 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9658 const address_space *aspace,
9659 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9660 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9661 {
9662 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9663 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9664 return 0;
9665
9666 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9667 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9668 }
9669
9670 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9671 ranged breakpoints. */
9672
9673 static int
9674 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9675 {
9676 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9677 }
9678
9679 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9680 ranged breakpoints. */
9681
9682 static enum print_stop_action
9683 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9684 {
9685 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9686 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9687 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9688
9689 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9690
9691 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9692 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9693
9694 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9695
9696 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9697
9698 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9699 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9700 else
9701 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9702 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9703 {
9704 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9705 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9706 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9707 }
9708 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
9709 uiout->text (", ");
9710
9711 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9712 }
9713
9714 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9715 ranged breakpoints. */
9716
9717 static void
9718 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9719 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9720 {
9721 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9722 struct value_print_options opts;
9723 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9724
9725 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9726 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9727
9728 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9729
9730 if (opts.addressprint)
9731 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9732 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9733 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9734 annotate_field (5);
9735 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9736 *last_loc = bl;
9737 }
9738
9739 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9740 ranged breakpoints. */
9741
9742 static void
9743 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9744 struct ui_out *uiout)
9745 {
9746 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9747 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9748 string_file stb;
9749
9750 gdb_assert (bl);
9751
9752 address_start = bl->address;
9753 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9754
9755 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9756 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9757 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9758 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9759 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9760 uiout->text ("\n");
9761 }
9762
9763 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9764 ranged breakpoints. */
9765
9766 static void
9767 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9768 {
9769 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9770 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9771
9772 gdb_assert (bl);
9773 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9774
9775 uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9776 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9777 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9778 }
9779
9780 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9781 ranged breakpoints. */
9782
9783 static void
9784 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9785 {
9786 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9787 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9788 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9789 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9790 }
9791
9792 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9793
9794 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9795
9796 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9797 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9798 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9799 last instruction of the given line. */
9800
9801 static CORE_ADDR
9802 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9803 {
9804 CORE_ADDR end;
9805
9806 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9807 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9808 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9809 end = sal.pc;
9810 else
9811 {
9812 int ret;
9813 CORE_ADDR start;
9814
9815 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9816 if (!ret)
9817 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9818
9819 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9820 end--;
9821 }
9822
9823 return end;
9824 }
9825
9826 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9827
9828 static void
9829 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9830 {
9831 const char *arg_start;
9832 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9833 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9834 CORE_ADDR end;
9835 struct breakpoint *b;
9836
9837 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9838 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9839 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9840
9841 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9842 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9843 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9844 bp_count, 0);
9845 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9846 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9847
9848 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9849 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9850 error(_("No address range specified."));
9851
9852 arg_start = arg;
9853 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9854 current_language);
9855 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9856
9857 if (arg[0] != ',')
9858 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9859 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9860 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9861
9862 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9863
9864 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9865 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
9866 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9867
9868 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
9869 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
9870
9871 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
9872 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9873
9874 /* Parse the end location. */
9875
9876 arg_start = arg;
9877
9878 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
9879 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
9880 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
9881 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
9882 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
9883 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9884 current_language);
9885 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9886 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
9887 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
9888
9889 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
9890 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9891
9892 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
9893 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
9894 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
9895 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
9896
9897 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
9898
9899 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
9900 if (sal_start.pc > end)
9901 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
9902
9903 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
9904 if (length < 0)
9905 /* Length overflowed. */
9906 error (_("Address range too large."));
9907 else if (length == 1)
9908 {
9909 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
9910 the `hbreak' command. */
9911 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
9912
9913 return;
9914 }
9915
9916 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
9917 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
9918 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
9919 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
9920 b->number = breakpoint_count;
9921 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9922 b->location = std::move (start_location);
9923 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
9924 b->loc->length = length;
9925
9926 mention (b);
9927 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
9928 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9929 }
9930
9931 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
9932 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
9933 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
9934 zero. */
9935
9936 static int
9937 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
9938 {
9939 int i = exp->nelts;
9940
9941 while (i > 0)
9942 {
9943 int oplenp, argsp;
9944
9945 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
9946 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
9947 i -= oplenp;
9948
9949 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
9950 {
9951 case BINOP_ADD:
9952 case BINOP_SUB:
9953 case BINOP_MUL:
9954 case BINOP_DIV:
9955 case BINOP_REM:
9956 case BINOP_MOD:
9957 case BINOP_LSH:
9958 case BINOP_RSH:
9959 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
9960 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
9961 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
9962 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
9963 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
9964 case BINOP_EQUAL:
9965 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
9966 case BINOP_LESS:
9967 case BINOP_GTR:
9968 case BINOP_LEQ:
9969 case BINOP_GEQ:
9970 case BINOP_REPEAT:
9971 case BINOP_COMMA:
9972 case BINOP_EXP:
9973 case BINOP_MIN:
9974 case BINOP_MAX:
9975 case BINOP_INTDIV:
9976 case BINOP_CONCAT:
9977 case TERNOP_COND:
9978 case TERNOP_SLICE:
9979
9980 case OP_LONG:
9981 case OP_FLOAT:
9982 case OP_LAST:
9983 case OP_COMPLEX:
9984 case OP_STRING:
9985 case OP_ARRAY:
9986 case OP_TYPE:
9987 case OP_TYPEOF:
9988 case OP_DECLTYPE:
9989 case OP_TYPEID:
9990 case OP_NAME:
9991 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
9992
9993 case UNOP_NEG:
9994 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
9995 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
9996 case UNOP_ADDR:
9997 case UNOP_HIGH:
9998 case UNOP_CAST:
9999
10000 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
10001 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
10002 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
10003 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
10004 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
10005 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
10006 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
10007
10008 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
10009 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
10010 ADDR is. */
10011 break;
10012
10013 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10014 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10015
10016 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10017 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10018 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10019 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10020
10021 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10022 are always constant. */
10023 {
10024 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10025
10026 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10027 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10028 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10029 return 0;
10030 break;
10031 }
10032
10033 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10034 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10035 then it is not a constant. */
10036 default:
10037 return 0;
10038 }
10039 }
10040
10041 return 1;
10042 }
10043
10044 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
10045
10046 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10047 {
10048 xfree (this->exp_string);
10049 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
10050 }
10051
10052 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10053
10054 static void
10055 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10056 {
10057 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10058
10059 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10060 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10061
10062 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10063 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10064 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10065 are loaded and unloaded.
10066
10067 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10068 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10069 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10070 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10071 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10072 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10073
10074 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10075 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10076 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10077 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10078
10079 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10080 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10081
10082 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10083 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10084 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10085 }
10086
10087 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10088
10089 static int
10090 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10091 {
10092 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10093 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10094
10095 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10096 w->cond_exp.get ());
10097 }
10098
10099 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10100
10101 static int
10102 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10103 {
10104 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10105 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10106
10107 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10108 w->cond_exp.get ());
10109 }
10110
10111 static int
10112 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10113 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10114 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10115 {
10116 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10117 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10118
10119 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10120 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10121 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10122 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10123 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10124 (did not match the data address). */
10125 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10126 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10127 return 0;
10128
10129 return 1;
10130 }
10131
10132 static void
10133 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10134 {
10135 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10136
10137 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10138 }
10139
10140 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10141 hardware watchpoints. */
10142
10143 static int
10144 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10145 {
10146 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10147 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10148
10149 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10150 }
10151
10152 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10153 hardware watchpoints. */
10154
10155 static int
10156 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10157 {
10158 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10159 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10160 }
10161
10162 static enum print_stop_action
10163 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10164 {
10165 struct breakpoint *b;
10166 enum print_stop_action result;
10167 struct watchpoint *w;
10168 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10169
10170 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10171
10172 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10173 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10174
10175 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10176 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10177
10178 string_file stb;
10179
10180 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10181 switch (b->type)
10182 {
10183 case bp_watchpoint:
10184 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10185 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10186 uiout->field_string
10187 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10188 mention (b);
10189 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10190 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10191 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10192 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10193 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10194 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10195 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10196 uiout->text ("\n");
10197 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10198 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10199 break;
10200
10201 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10202 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10203 uiout->field_string
10204 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10205 mention (b);
10206 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10207 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10208 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10209 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10210 uiout->text ("\n");
10211 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10212 break;
10213
10214 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10215 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10216 {
10217 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10218 uiout->field_string
10219 ("reason",
10220 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10221 mention (b);
10222 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10223 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10224 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10225 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10226 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10227 }
10228 else
10229 {
10230 mention (b);
10231 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10232 uiout->field_string
10233 ("reason",
10234 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10235 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10236 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10237 }
10238 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10239 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10240 uiout->text ("\n");
10241 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10242 break;
10243 default:
10244 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10245 }
10246
10247 return result;
10248 }
10249
10250 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10251 watchpoints. */
10252
10253 static void
10254 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10255 {
10256 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10257 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10258 const char *tuple_name;
10259
10260 switch (b->type)
10261 {
10262 case bp_watchpoint:
10263 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10264 tuple_name = "wpt";
10265 break;
10266 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10267 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10268 tuple_name = "wpt";
10269 break;
10270 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10271 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10272 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10273 break;
10274 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10275 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10276 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10277 break;
10278 default:
10279 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10280 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10281 }
10282
10283 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10284 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10285 uiout->text (": ");
10286 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10287 }
10288
10289 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10290 watchpoints. */
10291
10292 static void
10293 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10294 {
10295 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10296
10297 switch (b->type)
10298 {
10299 case bp_watchpoint:
10300 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10301 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10302 break;
10303 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10304 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10305 break;
10306 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10307 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10308 break;
10309 default:
10310 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10311 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10312 }
10313
10314 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10315 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10316 }
10317
10318 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10319 watchpoints. */
10320
10321 static int
10322 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10323 {
10324 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10325 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10326 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10327 return 0;
10328
10329 return 1;
10330 }
10331
10332 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10333
10334 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10335
10336 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10337 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10338
10339 static int
10340 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10341 {
10342 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10343
10344 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10345 bl->watchpoint_type);
10346 }
10347
10348 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10349 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10350
10351 static int
10352 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10353 {
10354 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10355
10356 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10357 bl->watchpoint_type);
10358 }
10359
10360 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10361 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10362
10363 static int
10364 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10365 {
10366 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10367
10368 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10369 }
10370
10371 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10372 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10373
10374 static int
10375 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10376 {
10377 return 0;
10378 }
10379
10380 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10381 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10382
10383 static enum print_stop_action
10384 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10385 {
10386 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10387 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10388
10389 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10390 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10391
10392 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10393 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10394
10395 switch (b->type)
10396 {
10397 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10398 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10399 uiout->field_string
10400 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10401 break;
10402
10403 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10404 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10405 uiout->field_string
10406 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10407 break;
10408
10409 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10410 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10411 uiout->field_string
10412 ("reason",
10413 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10414 break;
10415 default:
10416 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10417 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10418 }
10419
10420 mention (b);
10421 uiout->text (_("\n\
10422 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10423 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10424 uiout->text ("\n");
10425
10426 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10427 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10428 }
10429
10430 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10431 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10432
10433 static void
10434 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10435 struct ui_out *uiout)
10436 {
10437 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10438
10439 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10440 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10441
10442 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10443 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10444 uiout->text ("\n");
10445 }
10446
10447 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10448 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10449
10450 static void
10451 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10452 {
10453 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10454 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10455 const char *tuple_name;
10456
10457 switch (b->type)
10458 {
10459 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10460 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10461 tuple_name = "wpt";
10462 break;
10463 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10464 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10465 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10466 break;
10467 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10468 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10469 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10470 break;
10471 default:
10472 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10473 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10474 }
10475
10476 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10477 uiout->field_int ("number", b->number);
10478 uiout->text (": ");
10479 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10480 }
10481
10482 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10483 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10484
10485 static void
10486 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10487 {
10488 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10489 char tmp[40];
10490
10491 switch (b->type)
10492 {
10493 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10494 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10495 break;
10496 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10497 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10498 break;
10499 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10500 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10501 break;
10502 default:
10503 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10504 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10505 }
10506
10507 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
10508 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
10509 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10510 }
10511
10512 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10513
10514 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10515
10516 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10517
10518 static int
10519 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10520 {
10521 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10522 }
10523
10524 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10525 hw_read: watch read,
10526 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10527 static void
10528 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10529 int just_location, int internal)
10530 {
10531 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10532 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10533 struct value *mark, *result;
10534 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10535 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10536 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10537 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10538 int toklen = -1;
10539 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10540 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10541 enum bptype bp_type;
10542 int thread = -1;
10543 int pc = 0;
10544 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10545 the hardware watchpoint. */
10546 int use_mask = 0;
10547 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10548
10549 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10550 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10551 {
10552 const char *value_start;
10553
10554 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10555
10556 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10557 of the arguments string. */
10558 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10559 {
10560 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10561 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10562 tok--;
10563
10564 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10565 This is the value of the parameter. */
10566 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10567 tok--;
10568 value_start = tok + 1;
10569
10570 /* Skip whitespace. */
10571 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10572 tok--;
10573
10574 end_tok = tok;
10575
10576 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10577 This is the parameter itself. */
10578 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10579 tok--;
10580 tok++;
10581 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10582
10583 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10584 {
10585 struct thread_info *thr;
10586 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10587 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10588 only in a specific thread. */
10589 const char *endp;
10590
10591 if (thread != -1)
10592 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10593
10594 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10595 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10596
10597 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10598 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10599 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10600
10601 thread = thr->global_num;
10602 }
10603 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10604 {
10605 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10606 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10607 facility. */
10608 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10609
10610 if (use_mask)
10611 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10612
10613 use_mask = just_location = 1;
10614
10615 mark = value_mark ();
10616 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10617 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10618 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10619 }
10620 else
10621 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10622 break;
10623
10624 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10625 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10626 exp_end = tok;
10627 }
10628 }
10629 else
10630 exp_end = arg;
10631
10632 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10633 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10634 ARG. */
10635 innermost_block.reset ();
10636 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10637 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10638 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
10639 exp_end = arg;
10640 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10641 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10642 prettier. */
10643 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10644 --exp_end;
10645
10646 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10647 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10648 {
10649 int len;
10650
10651 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10652 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10653 len--;
10654 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10655 }
10656
10657 exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10658 mark = value_mark ();
10659 struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
10660 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), &pc, &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
10661 just_location);
10662
10663 if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
10664 {
10665 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
10666 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
10667 }
10668
10669 value_ref_ptr val;
10670 if (just_location)
10671 {
10672 int ret;
10673
10674 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10675 val = release_value (value_addr (result));
10676 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10677
10678 if (use_mask)
10679 {
10680 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
10681 mask);
10682 if (ret == -1)
10683 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10684 else if (ret == -2)
10685 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10686 }
10687 }
10688 else if (val_as_value != NULL)
10689 val = release_value (val_as_value);
10690
10691 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10692 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10693
10694 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10695 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10696 {
10697 innermost_block.reset ();
10698 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10699 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
10700
10701 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10702 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10703 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block.block ();
10704
10705 cond_end = tok;
10706 }
10707 if (*tok)
10708 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10709
10710 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10711
10712 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10713 'wp_frame'. */
10714 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10715
10716 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10717 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10718 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10719 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10720 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10721 {
10722 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10723
10724 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10725 {
10726 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10727 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10728
10729 scope_breakpoint
10730 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10731 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10732 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10733
10734 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10735 wp_frame = NULL;
10736
10737 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10738
10739 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10740 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10741
10742 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10743 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10744
10745 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10746 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10747 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10748 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10749 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10750 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10751 scope_breakpoint->type);
10752 }
10753 }
10754
10755 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10756 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10757 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10758 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10759
10760 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10761 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10762 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10763 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10764 else
10765 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10766
10767 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10768
10769 if (use_mask)
10770 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10771 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10772 else
10773 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10774 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10775 w->thread = thread;
10776 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10777 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10778 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10779 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10780 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10781 if (just_location)
10782 {
10783 struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
10784 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
10785
10786 w->exp_string_reparse
10787 = current_language->la_watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10788
10789 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10790 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10791 }
10792 else
10793 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10794
10795 if (use_mask)
10796 {
10797 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10798 }
10799 else
10800 {
10801 w->val = val;
10802 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10803 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10804 w->val_valid = 1;
10805 }
10806
10807 if (cond_start)
10808 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10809 else
10810 w->cond_string = 0;
10811
10812 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10813 {
10814 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10815 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10816 }
10817 else
10818 {
10819 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10820 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10821 }
10822
10823 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10824 {
10825 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10826 need to act on them together. */
10827 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10828 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10829 }
10830
10831 if (!just_location)
10832 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10833
10834 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10835 that should be inserted. */
10836 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10837
10838 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10839 }
10840
10841 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10842 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10843
10844 static int
10845 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
10846 {
10847 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10848
10849 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10850 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10851 return 0;
10852
10853 gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
10854 struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
10855
10856 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10857 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10858 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10859 hardware watchpoint.
10860
10861 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10862 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10863 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10864 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10865 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10866 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10867 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10868 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10869 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10870
10871 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10872 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10873 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10874 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10875 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
10876 {
10877 struct value *v = iter.get ();
10878
10879 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10880 {
10881 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10882 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10883 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10884 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10885 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10886 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10887 ;
10888 else
10889 {
10890 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10891 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10892 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10893
10894 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10895 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10896 middle of some value chain. */
10897 if (v == head
10898 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10899 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10900 {
10901 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10902 int len;
10903 int num_regs;
10904
10905 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10906 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10907 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10908
10909 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10910 if (!num_regs)
10911 return 0;
10912 else
10913 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10914 }
10915 }
10916 }
10917 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10918 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10919 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10920 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10921 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10922 }
10923
10924 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10925 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10926 return found_memory_cnt;
10927 }
10928
10929 void
10930 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10931 {
10932 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10933 }
10934
10935 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
10936 calls watch_command_1. */
10937
10938 static void
10939 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
10940 {
10941 int just_location = 0;
10942
10943 if (arg
10944 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
10945 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
10946 {
10947 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10948 just_location = 1;
10949 }
10950
10951 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
10952 }
10953
10954 static void
10955 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10956 {
10957 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
10958 }
10959
10960 void
10961 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10962 {
10963 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
10964 }
10965
10966 static void
10967 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10968 {
10969 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
10970 }
10971
10972 void
10973 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
10974 {
10975 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
10976 }
10977
10978 static void
10979 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
10980 {
10981 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
10982 }
10983 \f
10984
10985 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
10986 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
10987 breakpoints. */
10988
10989 struct until_break_fsm
10990 {
10991 /* The base class. */
10992 struct thread_fsm thread_fsm;
10993
10994 /* The thread that as current when the command was executed. */
10995 int thread;
10996
10997 /* The breakpoint set at the destination location. */
10998 struct breakpoint *location_breakpoint;
10999
11000 /* Breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame. May be
11001 NULL. */
11002 struct breakpoint *caller_breakpoint;
11003 };
11004
11005 static void until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11006 struct thread_info *thread);
11007 static int until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11008 struct thread_info *thread);
11009 static enum async_reply_reason
11010 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self);
11011
11012 /* until_break_fsm's vtable. */
11013
11014 static struct thread_fsm_ops until_break_fsm_ops =
11015 {
11016 NULL, /* dtor */
11017 until_break_fsm_clean_up,
11018 until_break_fsm_should_stop,
11019 NULL, /* return_value */
11020 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason,
11021 };
11022
11023 /* Allocate a new until_break_command_fsm. */
11024
11025 static struct until_break_fsm *
11026 new_until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
11027 breakpoint_up &&location_breakpoint,
11028 breakpoint_up &&caller_breakpoint)
11029 {
11030 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11031
11032 sm = XCNEW (struct until_break_fsm);
11033 thread_fsm_ctor (&sm->thread_fsm, &until_break_fsm_ops, cmd_interp);
11034
11035 sm->thread = thread;
11036 sm->location_breakpoint = location_breakpoint.release ();
11037 sm->caller_breakpoint = caller_breakpoint.release ();
11038
11039 return sm;
11040 }
11041
11042 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11043 until(location)/advance commands. */
11044
11045 static int
11046 until_break_fsm_should_stop (struct thread_fsm *self,
11047 struct thread_info *tp)
11048 {
11049 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11050
11051 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11052 sm->location_breakpoint) != NULL
11053 || (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL
11054 && bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11055 sm->caller_breakpoint) != NULL))
11056 thread_fsm_set_finished (self);
11057
11058 return 1;
11059 }
11060
11061 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11062 until(location)/advance commands. */
11063
11064 static void
11065 until_break_fsm_clean_up (struct thread_fsm *self,
11066 struct thread_info *thread)
11067 {
11068 struct until_break_fsm *sm = (struct until_break_fsm *) self;
11069
11070 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11071 if (sm->location_breakpoint != NULL)
11072 {
11073 delete_breakpoint (sm->location_breakpoint);
11074 sm->location_breakpoint = NULL;
11075 }
11076 if (sm->caller_breakpoint != NULL)
11077 {
11078 delete_breakpoint (sm->caller_breakpoint);
11079 sm->caller_breakpoint = NULL;
11080 }
11081 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (sm->thread);
11082 }
11083
11084 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11085 until(location)/advance commands. */
11086
11087 static enum async_reply_reason
11088 until_break_fsm_async_reply_reason (struct thread_fsm *self)
11089 {
11090 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11091 }
11092
11093 void
11094 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11095 {
11096 struct frame_info *frame;
11097 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11098 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11099 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11100 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11101 int thread;
11102 struct thread_info *tp;
11103 struct until_break_fsm *sm;
11104
11105 clear_proceed_status (0);
11106
11107 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11108 this function. */
11109
11110 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11111
11112 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
11113 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11114 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11115 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11116 get_last_displayed_line ())
11117 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11118 NULL, (struct symtab *) NULL, 0));
11119
11120 if (sals.size () != 1)
11121 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11122
11123 symtab_and_line &sal = sals[0];
11124
11125 if (*arg)
11126 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11127
11128 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11129
11130 tp = inferior_thread ();
11131 thread = tp->global_num;
11132
11133 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11134
11135 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11136 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11137 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11138 that. */
11139
11140 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11141 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11142 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11143 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11144
11145 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11146 one. */
11147
11148 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint;
11149 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11150 {
11151 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11152 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11153
11154 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11155 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11156 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11157 caller_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch,
11158 sal2,
11159 caller_frame_id,
11160 bp_until);
11161
11162 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11163 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11164 }
11165
11166 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11167 frame = NULL;
11168
11169 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint;
11170 if (anywhere)
11171 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11172 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11173 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11174 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11175 else
11176 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11177 only at the very same frame. */
11178 location_breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11179 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11180
11181 sm = new_until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11182 std::move (location_breakpoint),
11183 std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11184 tp->thread_fsm = &sm->thread_fsm;
11185
11186 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11187
11188 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11189 }
11190
11191 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11192 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11193
11194 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11195 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11196 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11197 if clause in the arg string. */
11198
11199 const char *
11200 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11201 {
11202 const char *cond_string;
11203
11204 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11205 return NULL;
11206
11207 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11208 (*arg) += 2;
11209
11210 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11211 condition string. */
11212 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11213 cond_string = *arg;
11214
11215 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11216 string. */
11217 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11218
11219 return cond_string;
11220 }
11221
11222 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11223 process start/exit, etc. */
11224
11225 typedef enum
11226 {
11227 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11228 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11229 }
11230 catch_fork_kind;
11231
11232 static void
11233 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11234 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11235 {
11236 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11237 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11238 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11239 int tempflag;
11240
11241 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11242 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11243 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11244
11245 if (!arg)
11246 arg = "";
11247 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11248
11249 /* The allowed syntax is:
11250 catch [v]fork
11251 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11252
11253 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11254 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11255
11256 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11257 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11258
11259 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11260 and enable reporting of such events. */
11261 switch (fork_kind)
11262 {
11263 case catch_fork_temporary:
11264 case catch_fork_permanent:
11265 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11266 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11267 break;
11268 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11269 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11270 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11271 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11272 break;
11273 default:
11274 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11275 break;
11276 }
11277 }
11278
11279 static void
11280 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11281 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11282 {
11283 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11284 int tempflag;
11285 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11286
11287 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11288
11289 if (!arg)
11290 arg = "";
11291 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11292
11293 /* The allowed syntax is:
11294 catch exec
11295 catch exec if <cond>
11296
11297 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11298 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11299
11300 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11301 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11302
11303 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11304 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11305 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11306 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11307
11308 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11309 }
11310
11311 void
11312 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11313 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11314 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11315 const char *addr_string,
11316 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11317 int tempflag,
11318 int enabled,
11319 int from_tty)
11320 {
11321 if (from_tty)
11322 {
11323 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11324 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11325 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11326
11327 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11328 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11329 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11330 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11331 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11332 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11333 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11334 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11335 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11336 enough for now, though. */
11337 }
11338
11339 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
11340
11341 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11342 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11343 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11344 language_def (language_ada));
11345 b->language = language_ada;
11346 }
11347
11348 static void
11349 catch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11350 {
11351 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11352 }
11353 \f
11354
11355 static void
11356 tcatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11357 {
11358 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
11359 }
11360
11361 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11362
11363 static int
11364 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11365 {
11366 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11367 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11368
11369 if (a->number < b->number)
11370 return -1;
11371 else if (a->number > b->number)
11372 return 1;
11373
11374 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11375 the number 0. */
11376 if (ua < ub)
11377 return -1;
11378 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11379 }
11380
11381 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11382
11383 static void
11384 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11385 {
11386 struct breakpoint *b;
11387 int default_match;
11388
11389 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11390 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11391 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11392 if (arg)
11393 {
11394 decoded_sals
11395 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11396 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11397 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11398 default_match = 0;
11399 sals = decoded_sals;
11400 }
11401 else
11402 {
11403 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11404 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11405 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11406 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11407 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11408 error (_("No source file specified."));
11409
11410 default_match = 1;
11411 sals = last_sal;
11412 }
11413
11414 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11415 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11416 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11417 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11418
11419 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11420 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11421 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11422 due to optimization, all in one block.
11423
11424 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11425 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11426 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11427 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11428 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11429 to support that. */
11430
11431 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11432 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11433 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11434 breakpoint. */
11435
11436 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11437 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11438 {
11439 const char *sal_fullname;
11440
11441 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11442 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11443 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11444 or at default pc.
11445
11446 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11447
11448 0 1 pc
11449 1 1 pc _and_ line
11450 0 0 line
11451 1 0 <can't happen> */
11452
11453 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11454 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11455
11456 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11457 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11458 {
11459 int match = 0;
11460 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11461 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11462 {
11463 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
11464 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
11465 {
11466 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11467 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11468 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11469 && sal.pc
11470 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11471 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11472 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11473 || loc->section == sal.section));
11474 int line_match = 0;
11475
11476 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11477 && loc->symtab != NULL
11478 && sal_fullname != NULL
11479 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11480 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11481 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11482 sal_fullname) == 0)
11483 line_match = 1;
11484
11485 if (pc_match || line_match)
11486 {
11487 match = 1;
11488 break;
11489 }
11490 }
11491 }
11492
11493 if (match)
11494 found.push_back (b);
11495 }
11496 }
11497
11498 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11499 if (found.empty ())
11500 {
11501 if (arg)
11502 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11503 else
11504 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11505 }
11506
11507 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11508 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11509 [] (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11510 {
11511 return compare_breakpoints (a, b) < 0;
11512 });
11513 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11514 [] (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11515 {
11516 return compare_breakpoints (a, b) == 0;
11517 }),
11518 found.end ());
11519
11520 if (found.size () > 1)
11521 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11522 if (from_tty)
11523 {
11524 if (found.size () == 1)
11525 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11526 else
11527 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11528 }
11529
11530 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11531 {
11532 if (from_tty)
11533 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11534 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11535 }
11536 if (from_tty)
11537 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11538 }
11539 \f
11540 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11541 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11542 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11543
11544 void
11545 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11546 {
11547 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
11548
11549 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11550 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11551 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11552 && bs->stop)
11553 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11554
11555 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
11556 {
11557 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11558 delete_breakpoint (b);
11559 }
11560 }
11561
11562 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11563 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11564 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
11565 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
11566 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
11567 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
11568
11569 static int
11570 bp_locations_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
11571 {
11572 const struct bp_location *a = *(const struct bp_location **) ap;
11573 const struct bp_location *b = *(const struct bp_location **) bp;
11574
11575 if (a->address != b->address)
11576 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
11577
11578 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11579 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11580 grouped. */
11581
11582 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11583 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
11584 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
11585
11586 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11587 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11588 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
11589
11590 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11591 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11592 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11593
11594 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11595 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
11596 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
11597
11598 return (a > b) - (a < b);
11599 }
11600
11601 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11602 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11603 content of the bp_locations array. */
11604
11605 static void
11606 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11607 {
11608 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
11609
11610 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11611 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11612
11613 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
11614 {
11615 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11616
11617 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11618 continue;
11619
11620 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11621 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11622
11623 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11624 addr = bl->address - start;
11625 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11626 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11627
11628 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11629
11630 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11631 addr = end - bl->address;
11632 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11633 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11634 }
11635 }
11636
11637 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11638
11639 static void
11640 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11641 {
11642 struct breakpoint *b;
11643 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11644
11645 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11646
11647 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
11648 {
11649 struct bp_location *bl;
11650 struct tracepoint *t;
11651 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11652
11653 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11654 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11655 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11656 continue;
11657
11658 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11659 {
11660 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11661 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11662 else
11663 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11664 }
11665
11666 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11667 break;
11668
11669 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
11670 {
11671 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11672 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11673 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11674 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11675 continue;
11676
11677 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11678
11679 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11680
11681 bl->inserted = 1;
11682 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11683 }
11684 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11685 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11686 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11687 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
11688 }
11689 }
11690
11691 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11692
11693 static void
11694 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11695 {
11696 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11697 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11698 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11699 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11700
11701 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11702 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11703 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11704 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11705 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11706
11707 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11708 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11709 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11710 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11711 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11712 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11713 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11714 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11715 }
11716
11717 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11718 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11719 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11720 the target. */
11721
11722 static void
11723 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11724 {
11725 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
11726 struct bp_location *loc;
11727 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11728 int pspace_num;
11729
11730 address = bl->address;
11731 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11732
11733 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11734 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11735 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11736 side. */
11737 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11738 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11739 return;
11740
11741 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11742 the same program space as the location
11743 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11744 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11745 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
11746 {
11747 loc = *loc2p;
11748
11749 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11750 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11751 continue;
11752
11753 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11754 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11755 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11756 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11757 that have already been marked. */
11758 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11759
11760 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11761 it later on. */
11762 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11763 }
11764 }
11765 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11766 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11767 locations are duplicate of which.
11768
11769 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11770 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11771 info. */
11772
11773 static void
11774 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11775 {
11776 struct breakpoint *b;
11777 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
11778 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11779 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11780 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11781 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11782
11783 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11784 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11785 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11786 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11787 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11788 once. */
11789 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11790 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11791 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11792 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11793
11794 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11795 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11796 struct bp_location **old_locp;
11797 unsigned old_locations_count;
11798 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<struct bp_location *> old_locations (bp_locations);
11799
11800 old_locations_count = bp_locations_count;
11801 bp_locations = NULL;
11802 bp_locations_count = 0;
11803
11804 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11805 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11806 bp_locations_count++;
11807
11808 bp_locations = XNEWVEC (struct bp_location *, bp_locations_count);
11809 locp = bp_locations;
11810 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
11811 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
11812 *locp++ = loc;
11813 qsort (bp_locations, bp_locations_count, sizeof (*bp_locations),
11814 bp_locations_compare);
11815
11816 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11817
11818 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11819 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11820 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11821 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11822 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11823 location.
11824
11825 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11826 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11827
11828 locp = bp_locations;
11829 for (old_locp = old_locations.get ();
11830 old_locp < old_locations.get () + old_locations_count;
11831 old_locp++)
11832 {
11833 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
11834 struct bp_location **loc2p;
11835
11836 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11837 not, we have to free it. */
11838 int found_object = 0;
11839 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11840 int keep_in_target = 0;
11841 int removed = 0;
11842
11843 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11844 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11845 while (locp < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11846 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
11847 locp++;
11848
11849 for (loc2p = locp;
11850 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11851 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11852 loc2p++)
11853 {
11854 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11855 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11856 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11857 place there. */
11858 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
11859 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11860 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11861 {
11862 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
11863 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11864 }
11865
11866 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
11867 found_object = 1;
11868 }
11869
11870 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11871 have to go through updates again. */
11872 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11873
11874 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11875 if (!found_object)
11876 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11877
11878 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11879 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11880 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11881 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11882 at certain location is not inserted. */
11883
11884 if (old_loc->inserted)
11885 {
11886 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11887 it. */
11888
11889 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11890 {
11891 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11892 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11893 keep_in_target = 1;
11894 }
11895 else
11896 {
11897 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11898 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11899 remove its target-side condition. */
11900
11901 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11902 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11903 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11904 this one from the target. */
11905
11906 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11907 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
11908 {
11909 for (loc2p = locp;
11910 (loc2p < bp_locations + bp_locations_count
11911 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
11912 loc2p++)
11913 {
11914 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
11915
11916 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11917 {
11918 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11919 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11920 supported, but the latter are. */
11921 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11922 {
11923 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11924 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11925 }
11926
11927 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11928 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11929 unduplicated. */
11930 if (loc2 != old_loc
11931 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
11932 {
11933 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
11934 keep_in_target = 1;
11935 break;
11936 }
11937 }
11938 }
11939 }
11940 }
11941
11942 if (!keep_in_target)
11943 {
11944 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
11945 {
11946 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11947 this location on the global list, and try to
11948 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11949 reason why we will succeed next time.
11950
11951 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11952 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11953 only after calling us. */
11954 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
11955 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11956 old_loc->owner->number);
11957 }
11958 removed = 1;
11959 }
11960 }
11961
11962 if (!found_object)
11963 {
11964 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
11965 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
11966 {
11967 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11968 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11969 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11970 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11971 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11972 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11973 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11974 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11975 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11976 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11977 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11978 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11979 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11980 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11981 SIGTRAP.
11982
11983 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
11984 decr_pc_after_break targets.
11985
11986 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
11987 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
11988 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
11989 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
11990 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
11991 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
11992 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
11993 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
11994 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
11995 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
11996 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
11997 targets that do not support new thread events, like
11998 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
11999 thread_count.
12000
12001 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12002 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12003 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12004 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12005
12006 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12007 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12008 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12009 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12010 traps we can no longer explain. */
12011
12012 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12013 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12014
12015 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12016 }
12017 else
12018 {
12019 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12020 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12021 }
12022 }
12023 }
12024
12025 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12026 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12027 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12028 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12029 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12030 are sorted first for the same address.
12031
12032 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12033 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12034
12035 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12036 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12037 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12038 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12039 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12040 {
12041 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12042 non-NULL. */
12043 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12044 b = loc->owner;
12045
12046 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12047 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12048 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12049 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12050 `struct bp_location'. */
12051 || is_tracepoint (b))
12052 {
12053 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12054 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12055 continue;
12056 }
12057
12058 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12059 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12060 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12061 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12062 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12063 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12064 else
12065 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12066
12067 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12068 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12069 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12070 {
12071 *loc_first_p = loc;
12072 loc->duplicate = 0;
12073
12074 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12075 {
12076 loc->needs_update = 1;
12077 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12078 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12079 }
12080 continue;
12081 }
12082
12083
12084 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12085 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12086 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12087 if (loc->inserted)
12088 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12089 loc->duplicate = 1;
12090
12091 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12092 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12093 }
12094
12095 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12096 {
12097 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12098 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12099 else
12100 {
12101 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12102 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12103 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12104 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12105 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12106 "needs_update". */
12107 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12108 }
12109 }
12110
12111 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12112 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12113 }
12114
12115 void
12116 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12117 {
12118 struct bp_location *loc;
12119 int ix;
12120
12121 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12122 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12123 {
12124 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12125 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12126 --ix;
12127 }
12128 }
12129
12130 static void
12131 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12132 {
12133
12134 TRY
12135 {
12136 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12137 }
12138 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12139 {
12140 }
12141 END_CATCH
12142 }
12143
12144 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12145
12146 static void
12147 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12148 {
12149 bpstat bs;
12150
12151 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12152 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12153 {
12154 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12155 bs->old_val = NULL;
12156 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12157 }
12158 }
12159
12160 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12161 static int
12162 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12163 {
12164 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12165
12166 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12167 return 0;
12168 }
12169
12170 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12171 callbacks. */
12172
12173 static void
12174 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12175 {
12176 struct value_print_options opts;
12177
12178 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12179
12180 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12181 single string. */
12182 if (b->loc == NULL)
12183 {
12184 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12185 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12186 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12187 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12188 {
12189 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12190 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12191 }
12192 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12193 {
12194 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12195 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12196 b->extra_string);
12197 }
12198 else
12199 {
12200 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12201 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12202 b->extra_string);
12203 }
12204 }
12205 else
12206 {
12207 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12208 {
12209 printf_filtered (" at ");
12210 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12211 gdb_stdout);
12212 }
12213 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12214 {
12215 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12216 more nicely. */
12217 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12218 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12219 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
12220 b->loc->line_number);
12221 else
12222 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12223 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12224 real situation somewhat. */
12225 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12226 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12227 }
12228
12229 if (b->loc->next)
12230 {
12231 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12232 int n = 0;
12233 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12234 ++n;
12235 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12236 }
12237 }
12238 }
12239
12240 /* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
12241
12242 static void
12243 bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
12244 {
12245 xfree (self->function_name);
12246 }
12247
12248 static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
12249 {
12250 bp_location_dtor
12251 };
12252
12253 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12254
12255 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12256 {
12257 xfree (this->cond_string);
12258 xfree (this->extra_string);
12259 xfree (this->filter);
12260 }
12261
12262 static struct bp_location *
12263 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12264 {
12265 return new bp_location (&bp_location_ops, self);
12266 }
12267
12268 static void
12269 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12270 {
12271 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12272 }
12273
12274 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12275 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12276
12277 static int
12278 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12279 {
12280 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12281 }
12282
12283 static int
12284 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12285 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12286 {
12287 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12288 }
12289
12290 static int
12291 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12292 const address_space *aspace,
12293 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12294 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12295 {
12296 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12297 }
12298
12299 static void
12300 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12301 {
12302 /* Always stop. */
12303 }
12304
12305 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12306 errors. */
12307
12308 static int
12309 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12310 {
12311 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12312 }
12313
12314 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12315 errors. */
12316
12317 static int
12318 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12319 {
12320 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12321 }
12322
12323 static enum print_stop_action
12324 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12325 {
12326 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12327 }
12328
12329 static void
12330 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12331 struct ui_out *uiout)
12332 {
12333 /* nothing */
12334 }
12335
12336 static void
12337 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12338 {
12339 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12340 }
12341
12342 static void
12343 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12344 {
12345 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12346 }
12347
12348 static void
12349 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12350 (const struct event_location *location,
12351 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12352 enum bptype type_wanted)
12353 {
12354 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12355 }
12356
12357 static void
12358 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12359 struct linespec_result *c,
12360 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12361 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12362 enum bptype type_wanted,
12363 enum bpdisp disposition,
12364 int thread,
12365 int task, int ignore_count,
12366 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12367 int from_tty, int enabled,
12368 int internal, unsigned flags)
12369 {
12370 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12371 }
12372
12373 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12374 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12375 const struct event_location *location,
12376 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12377 {
12378 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12379 }
12380
12381 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12382
12383 static int
12384 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12385 {
12386 return 1;
12387 }
12388
12389 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12390
12391 static void
12392 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12393 {
12394 /* Nothing to do. */
12395 }
12396
12397 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12398 {
12399 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12400 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12401 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12402 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12403 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12404 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12405 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12406 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12407 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12408 NULL,
12409 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12410 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12411 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12412 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12413 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12414 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12415 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12416 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12417 };
12418
12419 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12420
12421 static void
12422 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12423 {
12424 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12425 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12426 {
12427 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12428 delete_breakpoint (b);
12429 return;
12430 }
12431
12432 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12433 }
12434
12435 static int
12436 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12437 {
12438 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12439
12440 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12441 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12442
12443 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12444 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12445 else
12446 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12447 }
12448
12449 static int
12450 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12451 {
12452 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12453 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12454 else
12455 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12456 }
12457
12458 static int
12459 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12460 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12461 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12462 {
12463 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12464 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12465 return 0;
12466
12467 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12468 aspace, bp_addr))
12469 return 0;
12470
12471 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12472 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12473 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12474 return 0;
12475
12476 return 1;
12477 }
12478
12479 static int
12480 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12481 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12482 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12483 {
12484 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12485 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12486 {
12487 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12488 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12489 be set at the same address. */
12490 return 0;
12491 }
12492
12493 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12494 }
12495
12496 static int
12497 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12498 {
12499 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12500
12501 return 1;
12502 }
12503
12504 static enum print_stop_action
12505 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12506 {
12507 struct breakpoint *b;
12508 const struct bp_location *bl;
12509 int bp_temp;
12510 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12511
12512 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12513
12514 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
12515 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12516
12517 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12518 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12519 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12520 bl->address,
12521 b->number, 1);
12522 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12523 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12524
12525 if (bp_temp)
12526 uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint ");
12527 else
12528 uiout->text ("Breakpoint ");
12529 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12530 {
12531 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12532 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12533 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12534 }
12535 uiout->field_int ("bkptno", b->number);
12536 uiout->text (", ");
12537
12538 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12539 }
12540
12541 static void
12542 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12543 {
12544 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12545 return;
12546
12547 switch (b->type)
12548 {
12549 case bp_breakpoint:
12550 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12551 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12552 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12553 else
12554 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12555 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12556 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12557 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12558 break;
12559 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12560 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12561 break;
12562 case bp_dprintf:
12563 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12564 break;
12565 }
12566
12567 say_where (b);
12568 }
12569
12570 static void
12571 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12572 {
12573 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12574 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12575 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12576 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12577 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12578 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12579 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12580 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12581 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12582 else
12583 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12584 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12585
12586 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12587 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12588
12589 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12590 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12591 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12592 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12593
12594 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12595 }
12596
12597 static void
12598 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12599 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12600 enum bptype type_wanted)
12601 {
12602 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12603 }
12604
12605 static void
12606 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12607 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12608 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12609 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12610 enum bptype type_wanted,
12611 enum bpdisp disposition,
12612 int thread,
12613 int task, int ignore_count,
12614 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12615 int from_tty, int enabled,
12616 int internal, unsigned flags)
12617 {
12618 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12619 std::move (cond_string),
12620 std::move (extra_string),
12621 type_wanted,
12622 disposition, thread, task,
12623 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12624 enabled, internal, flags);
12625 }
12626
12627 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12628 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12629 const struct event_location *location,
12630 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12631 {
12632 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12633 }
12634
12635 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12636
12637 static void
12638 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12639 {
12640 switch (b->type)
12641 {
12642 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12643 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12644 case bp_overlay_event:
12645 case bp_longjmp_master:
12646 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12647 case bp_exception_master:
12648 delete_breakpoint (b);
12649 break;
12650
12651 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12652 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12653 case bp_shlib_event:
12654
12655 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12656 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12657 case bp_thread_event:
12658 break;
12659 }
12660 }
12661
12662 static void
12663 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12664 {
12665 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12666 {
12667 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12668 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12669 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12670 objects (among other things). */
12671 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12672 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12673 }
12674 else
12675 bs->stop = 0;
12676 }
12677
12678 static enum print_stop_action
12679 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12680 {
12681 struct breakpoint *b;
12682
12683 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12684
12685 switch (b->type)
12686 {
12687 case bp_shlib_event:
12688 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12689 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12690 to shlib event" message.) */
12691 print_solib_event (0);
12692 break;
12693
12694 case bp_thread_event:
12695 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12696 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12697 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12698 break;
12699
12700 case bp_overlay_event:
12701 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12702 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12703 break;
12704
12705 case bp_longjmp_master:
12706 /* These should never be enabled. */
12707 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12708 break;
12709
12710 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12711 /* These should never be enabled. */
12712 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12713 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12714 break;
12715
12716 case bp_exception_master:
12717 /* These should never be enabled. */
12718 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12719 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12720 break;
12721 }
12722
12723 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12724 }
12725
12726 static void
12727 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12728 {
12729 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12730 }
12731
12732 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12733
12734 static void
12735 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12736 {
12737 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12738 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12739 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12740 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12741 }
12742
12743 static void
12744 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12745 {
12746 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12747 }
12748
12749 static enum print_stop_action
12750 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12751 {
12752 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12753 }
12754
12755 static void
12756 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12757 {
12758 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12759 }
12760
12761 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12762
12763 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12764 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12765
12766 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12767 {
12768 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12769
12770 if (tp != NULL)
12771 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12772 }
12773
12774 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12775
12776 static int
12777 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12778 {
12779 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12780
12781 if (v == 0)
12782 {
12783 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12784 if needed. */
12785 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12786 }
12787
12788 return v;
12789 }
12790
12791 static int
12792 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12793 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12794 {
12795 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12796 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12797
12798 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12799 }
12800
12801 static void
12802 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12803 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12804 enum bptype type_wanted)
12805 {
12806 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12807
12808 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12809 lsal.canonical
12810 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12811 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12812 }
12813
12814 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12815 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12816 const struct event_location *location,
12817 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12818 {
12819 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12820 if (sals.empty ())
12821 error (_("probe not found"));
12822 return sals;
12823 }
12824
12825 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12826
12827 static void
12828 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12829 {
12830 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12831 }
12832
12833 static int
12834 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12835 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12836 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12837 {
12838 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12839 tracepoints. */
12840 return 0;
12841 }
12842
12843 static void
12844 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12845 struct ui_out *uiout)
12846 {
12847 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12848 if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12849 {
12850 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12851
12852 uiout->text ("\tmarker id is ");
12853 uiout->field_string ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12854 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
12855 uiout->text ("\n");
12856 }
12857 }
12858
12859 static void
12860 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12861 {
12862 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12863 return;
12864
12865 switch (b->type)
12866 {
12867 case bp_tracepoint:
12868 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12869 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12870 break;
12871 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12872 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12873 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12874 break;
12875 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12876 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12877 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12878 break;
12879 default:
12880 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12881 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12882 }
12883
12884 say_where (b);
12885 }
12886
12887 static void
12888 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12889 {
12890 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12891
12892 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12893 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
12894 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12895 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
12896 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12897 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
12898 else
12899 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12900 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12901
12902 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12903 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12904 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12905
12906 if (tp->pass_count)
12907 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12908 }
12909
12910 static void
12911 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
12912 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12913 enum bptype type_wanted)
12914 {
12915 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12916 }
12917
12918 static void
12919 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12920 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12921 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12922 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12923 enum bptype type_wanted,
12924 enum bpdisp disposition,
12925 int thread,
12926 int task, int ignore_count,
12927 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12928 int from_tty, int enabled,
12929 int internal, unsigned flags)
12930 {
12931 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12932 std::move (cond_string),
12933 std::move (extra_string),
12934 type_wanted,
12935 disposition, thread, task,
12936 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12937 enabled, internal, flags);
12938 }
12939
12940 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12941 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12942 const struct event_location *location,
12943 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12944 {
12945 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12946 }
12947
12948 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
12949
12950 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
12951 static probe. */
12952
12953 static void
12954 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12955 (const struct event_location *location,
12956 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12957 enum bptype type_wanted)
12958 {
12959 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12960 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12961 }
12962
12963 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12964 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12965 const struct event_location *location,
12966 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12967 {
12968 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12969 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
12970 }
12971
12972 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
12973
12974 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
12975
12976 static void
12977 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12978 {
12979 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12980
12981 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
12982 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
12983
12984 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
12985 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
12986 3 - disconnect from target 1
12987 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
12988
12989 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
12990 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
12991 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
12992 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
12993 it all the time. */
12994 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
12995 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
12996 }
12997
12998 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
12999
13000 static void
13001 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13002 {
13003 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
13004 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
13005 tp->extra_string);
13006 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13007 }
13008
13009 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13010 dprintf.
13011
13012 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13013 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13014 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13015 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13016 address are all handled. */
13017
13018 static void
13019 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13020 {
13021 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
13022 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13023
13024 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13025 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13026 condition not be evaluated. */
13027 bs->stop = 0;
13028
13029 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13030 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13031 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13032 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13033 commands here throws. */
13034 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13035 bs->commands = NULL;
13036
13037 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13038
13039 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13040 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13041 list. */
13042 }
13043
13044 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13045 markers (`-m'). */
13046
13047 static void
13048 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (const struct event_location *location,
13049 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13050 enum bptype type_wanted)
13051 {
13052 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13053 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13054
13055 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13056 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13057
13058 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13059 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
13060 canonical->location
13061 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
13062
13063 lsal.canonical
13064 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
13065 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
13066 }
13067
13068 static void
13069 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13070 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13071 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13072 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13073 enum bptype type_wanted,
13074 enum bpdisp disposition,
13075 int thread,
13076 int task, int ignore_count,
13077 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13078 int from_tty, int enabled,
13079 int internal, unsigned flags)
13080 {
13081 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
13082
13083 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13084 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13085 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13086 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13087 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13088 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13089
13090 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
13091 {
13092 event_location_up location
13093 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
13094
13095 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
13096 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
13097 std::move (location), NULL,
13098 std::move (cond_string),
13099 std::move (extra_string),
13100 type_wanted, disposition,
13101 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13102 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13103 canonical->special_display);
13104 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13105 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13106 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13107 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13108 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13109 corresponds to this one */
13110 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13111
13112 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
13113 }
13114 }
13115
13116 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13117 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13118 const struct event_location *location,
13119 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13120 {
13121 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13122 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13123
13124 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13125 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13126 {
13127 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13128 sals.resize (1);
13129 return sals;
13130 }
13131 else
13132 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13133 }
13134
13135 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13136
13137 static int
13138 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13139 {
13140 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13141 }
13142
13143 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13144 structures. */
13145
13146 void
13147 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13148 {
13149 struct breakpoint *b;
13150
13151 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13152
13153 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13154 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13155 especial culprits.
13156
13157 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13158 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13159 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13160 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13161 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13162 deleted.
13163
13164 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13165 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13166 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13167 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13168 was chosen. */
13169 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13170 return;
13171
13172 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13173 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13174 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13175 {
13176 struct breakpoint *related;
13177 struct watchpoint *w;
13178
13179 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13180 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13181 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13182 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13183 else
13184 w = NULL;
13185 if (w != NULL)
13186 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13187
13188 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13189 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13190 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13191 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13192 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13193 }
13194
13195 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13196 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13197 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13198 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13199 if (bpt->number)
13200 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
13201
13202 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13203 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13204
13205 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13206 if (b->next == bpt)
13207 {
13208 b->next = bpt->next;
13209 break;
13210 }
13211
13212 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13213 been freed. */
13214 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13215 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13216 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13217 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13218 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13219 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13220 commands won't work. */
13221
13222 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13223
13224 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13225 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13226 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13227 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13228 might be better design to have location completely
13229 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13230 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13231
13232 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13233 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13234 bpt->type = bp_none;
13235 delete bpt;
13236 }
13237
13238 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13239 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13240
13241 static void
13242 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13243 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13244 {
13245 struct breakpoint *related;
13246
13247 related = b;
13248 do
13249 {
13250 struct breakpoint *next;
13251
13252 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13253 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13254
13255 if (next == related)
13256 {
13257 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13258 function (related);
13259
13260 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13261 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13262 out. */
13263 break;
13264 }
13265 else
13266 function (related);
13267
13268 related = next;
13269 }
13270 while (related != b);
13271 }
13272
13273 static void
13274 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13275 {
13276 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13277
13278 dont_repeat ();
13279
13280 if (arg == 0)
13281 {
13282 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13283
13284 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13285 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13286 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13287 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13288 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13289 {
13290 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13291 break;
13292 }
13293
13294 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13295 if (!from_tty
13296 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13297 {
13298 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13299 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13300 delete_breakpoint (b);
13301 }
13302 }
13303 else
13304 map_breakpoint_numbers
13305 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
13306 {
13307 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, delete_breakpoint);
13308 });
13309 }
13310
13311 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13312 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13313 considered. */
13314
13315 static int
13316 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13317 {
13318 struct bp_location *loc;
13319
13320 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
13321 if ((pspace == NULL
13322 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13323 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13324 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13325 return 0;
13326 return 1;
13327 }
13328
13329 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13330 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13331 Null names are ignored. */
13332
13333 static int
13334 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13335 {
13336 struct bp_location *l;
13337 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, streq_hash, NULL,
13338 xcalloc, xfree);
13339
13340 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13341 {
13342 const char **slot;
13343 const char *name = l->function_name;
13344
13345 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13346 if (name == NULL)
13347 continue;
13348
13349 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
13350 INSERT);
13351 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13352 returns NULL. */
13353 if (*slot != NULL)
13354 {
13355 htab_delete (htab);
13356 return 1;
13357 }
13358 *slot = name;
13359 }
13360
13361 htab_delete (htab);
13362 return 0;
13363 }
13364
13365 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13366 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13367 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13368 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13369 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13370 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13371 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13372 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13373 The heuristic is:
13374
13375 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13376 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13377 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13378 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13379 in the sources, and output a warning.
13380
13381 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13382 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13383 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13384 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13385 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13386 warning.
13387
13388 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13389 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13390 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13391 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13392 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13393 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13394 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13395 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13396 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13397
13398 static struct symtab_and_line
13399 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13400 {
13401 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13402 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13403 CORE_ADDR pc;
13404
13405 pc = sal.pc;
13406 if (sal.line)
13407 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13408
13409 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13410 {
13411 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
13412 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13413 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
13414 marker.str_id.c_str ());
13415
13416 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
13417
13418 return sal;
13419 }
13420
13421 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13422 by string ID. */
13423 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13424 && sal.line != 0
13425 && sal.symtab != NULL
13426 && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
13427 {
13428 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
13429 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
13430 (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13431
13432 if (!markers.empty ())
13433 {
13434 struct symbol *sym;
13435 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13436 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13437 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13438
13439 tpmarker = &markers[0];
13440
13441 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
13442
13443 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13444 "found at previous line number"),
13445 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13446
13447 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13448 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13449 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13450 if (sym)
13451 {
13452 uiout->field_string ("func", SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
13453 uiout->text (" at ");
13454 }
13455 uiout->field_string ("file",
13456 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13457 uiout->text (":");
13458
13459 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13460 {
13461 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13462
13463 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13464 }
13465
13466 uiout->field_int ("line", sal2.line);
13467 uiout->text ("\n");
13468
13469 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13470 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13471
13472 b->location.reset (NULL);
13473 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13474 explicit_loc.source_filename
13475 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13476 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13477 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13478 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13479
13480 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13481 so. */
13482 }
13483 }
13484 return sal;
13485 }
13486
13487 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13488 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13489
13490 static int
13491 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13492 {
13493 while (a && b)
13494 {
13495 if (a->address != b->address)
13496 return 0;
13497
13498 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13499 return 0;
13500
13501 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13502 return 0;
13503
13504 a = a->next;
13505 b = b->next;
13506 }
13507
13508 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13509 return 0;
13510
13511 return 1;
13512 }
13513
13514 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13515 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13516 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13517
13518 static struct bp_location *
13519 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13520 {
13521 struct bp_location head;
13522 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13523 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13524 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13525
13526 if (pspace == NULL)
13527 {
13528 i = b->loc;
13529 b->loc = NULL;
13530 return i;
13531 }
13532
13533 head.next = NULL;
13534
13535 while (i != NULL)
13536 {
13537 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13538 {
13539 *i_link = i->next;
13540 i->next = NULL;
13541 hoisted->next = i;
13542 hoisted = i;
13543 }
13544 else
13545 i_link = &i->next;
13546 i = *i_link;
13547 }
13548
13549 return head.next;
13550 }
13551
13552 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13553 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13554 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13555 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13556 untouched. */
13557
13558 void
13559 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13560 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13561 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13562 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13563 {
13564 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13565
13566 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13567 {
13568 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13569 location. */
13570 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13571 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13572 "multiple locations found\n"),
13573 b->number);
13574 return;
13575 }
13576
13577 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13578 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13579 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13580 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13581 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13582 individual locations. */
13583 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13584 return;
13585
13586 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13587
13588 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13589 {
13590 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13591
13592 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13593
13594 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13595
13596 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13597 old symtab. */
13598 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13599 {
13600 const char *s;
13601
13602 s = b->cond_string;
13603 TRY
13604 {
13605 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13606 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13607 0);
13608 }
13609 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13610 {
13611 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
13612 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
13613 b->number, e.message);
13614 new_loc->enabled = 0;
13615 }
13616 END_CATCH
13617 }
13618
13619 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13620 {
13621 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13622
13623 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13624 }
13625 }
13626
13627 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13628 breakpoints. */
13629 {
13630 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13631 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13632 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13633 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13634 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13635 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13636 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13637
13638 for (; e; e = e->next)
13639 {
13640 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
13641 {
13642 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
13643 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13644 {
13645 for (; l; l = l->next)
13646 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
13647 {
13648 l->enabled = 0;
13649 break;
13650 }
13651 }
13652 else
13653 {
13654 for (; l; l = l->next)
13655 if (l->function_name
13656 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13657 {
13658 l->enabled = 0;
13659 break;
13660 }
13661 }
13662 }
13663 }
13664 }
13665
13666 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13667 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13668 }
13669
13670 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13671 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13672
13673 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13674 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13675 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13676 {
13677 struct gdb_exception exception = exception_none;
13678
13679 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13680
13681 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13682
13683 TRY
13684 {
13685 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13686 }
13687 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
13688 {
13689 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13690
13691 exception = e;
13692
13693 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13694 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13695 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13696 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13697 state, then user already saw the message about that
13698 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13699 errors. */
13700 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13701 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13702 || (b->loc != NULL
13703 && search_pspace != NULL
13704 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13705 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13706 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13707 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13708 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13709
13710 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13711 {
13712 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13713 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13714 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13715 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13716 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13717 which approach is better. */
13718 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13719 throw_exception (e);
13720 }
13721 }
13722 END_CATCH
13723
13724 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13725 {
13726 for (auto &sal : sals)
13727 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13728 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13729 {
13730 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13731 int thread, task;
13732
13733 find_condition_and_thread (b->extra_string, sals[0].pc,
13734 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
13735 &extra_string);
13736 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13737 if (cond_string)
13738 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13739 b->thread = thread;
13740 b->task = task;
13741 if (extra_string)
13742 {
13743 xfree (b->extra_string);
13744 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13745 }
13746 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13747 }
13748
13749 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13750 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13751
13752 *found = 1;
13753 }
13754 else
13755 *found = 0;
13756
13757 return sals;
13758 }
13759
13760 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13761 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13762 locations. */
13763
13764 static void
13765 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13766 {
13767 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13768 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13769
13770 int found;
13771 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13772 filter_pspace, &found);
13773 if (found)
13774 expanded = std::move (sals);
13775
13776 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13777 {
13778 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13779 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13780 filter_pspace, &found);
13781 if (found)
13782 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13783 }
13784
13785 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13786 }
13787
13788 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13789 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13790
13791 static void
13792 create_sals_from_location_default (const struct event_location *location,
13793 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13794 enum bptype type_wanted)
13795 {
13796 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13797 }
13798
13799 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13800 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13801 breakpoint_ops. */
13802
13803 static void
13804 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13805 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13806 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13807 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13808 enum bptype type_wanted,
13809 enum bpdisp disposition,
13810 int thread,
13811 int task, int ignore_count,
13812 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13813 int from_tty, int enabled,
13814 int internal, unsigned flags)
13815 {
13816 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13817 std::move (cond_string),
13818 std::move (extra_string),
13819 type_wanted, disposition,
13820 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13821 enabled, internal, flags);
13822 }
13823
13824 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13825 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13826
13827 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13828 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13829 const struct event_location *location,
13830 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13831 {
13832 struct linespec_result canonical;
13833
13834 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13835 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
13836 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13837 b->filter);
13838
13839 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13840 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13841
13842 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13843 {
13844 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13845 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13846 }
13847 return {};
13848 }
13849
13850 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13851
13852 static void
13853 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13854 {
13855 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13856 set_language (b->language);
13857
13858 b->ops->re_set (b);
13859 }
13860
13861 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13862 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13863
13864 void
13865 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13866 {
13867 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
13868
13869 {
13870 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13871 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13872 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13873
13874 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13875 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13876 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13877 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13878 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13879 we select the current frame.
13880
13881 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13882 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13883 have been reset. */
13884 scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
13885 language_mode = language_mode_manual;
13886
13887 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13888 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13889 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13890 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13891
13892 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
13893 {
13894 TRY
13895 {
13896 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13897 }
13898 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
13899 {
13900 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13901 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13902 b->number);
13903 }
13904 END_CATCH
13905 }
13906
13907 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13908 }
13909
13910 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13911 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13912 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13913 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13914
13915 /* Now we can insert. */
13916 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13917 }
13918 \f
13919 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13920
13921 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13922 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13923 void
13924 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13925 {
13926 if (b->thread != -1)
13927 {
13928 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
13929
13930 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13931 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13932 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13933 as well. */
13934 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
13935 }
13936 }
13937
13938 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13939 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13940 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13941
13942 void
13943 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
13944 {
13945 struct breakpoint *b;
13946
13947 if (count < 0)
13948 count = 0;
13949
13950 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
13951 if (b->number == bptnum)
13952 {
13953 if (is_tracepoint (b))
13954 {
13955 if (from_tty && count != 0)
13956 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13957 bptnum);
13958 return;
13959 }
13960
13961 b->ignore_count = count;
13962 if (from_tty)
13963 {
13964 if (count == 0)
13965 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
13966 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13967 bptnum);
13968 else if (count == 1)
13969 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13970 bptnum);
13971 else
13972 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
13973 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13974 count, bptnum);
13975 }
13976 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13977 return;
13978 }
13979
13980 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
13981 }
13982
13983 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
13984
13985 static void
13986 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13987 {
13988 const char *p = args;
13989 int num;
13990
13991 if (p == 0)
13992 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
13993
13994 num = get_number (&p);
13995 if (num == 0)
13996 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
13997 if (*p == 0)
13998 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
13999
14000 set_ignore_count (num,
14001 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14002 from_tty);
14003 if (from_tty)
14004 printf_filtered ("\n");
14005 }
14006 \f
14007
14008 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
14009 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
14010
14011 static void
14012 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
14013 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14014 {
14015 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
14016 {
14017 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
14018 bp_num_range.first);
14019 }
14020 else
14021 {
14022 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14023
14024 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
14025 {
14026 bool match = false;
14027
14028 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14029 if (b->number == i)
14030 {
14031 match = true;
14032 function (b);
14033 break;
14034 }
14035 if (!match)
14036 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
14037 }
14038 }
14039 }
14040
14041 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
14042 ARGS. */
14043
14044 static void
14045 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
14046 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14047 {
14048 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14049 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14050
14051 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14052
14053 while (!parser.finished ())
14054 {
14055 int num = parser.get_number ();
14056 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
14057 }
14058 }
14059
14060 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
14061 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
14062
14063 static struct bp_location *
14064 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
14065 {
14066 struct breakpoint *b;
14067
14068 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14069 if (b->number == bp_num)
14070 {
14071 break;
14072 }
14073
14074 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14075 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
14076
14077 if (loc_num == 0)
14078 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14079
14080 int n = 0;
14081 for (bp_location *loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14082 if (++n == loc_num)
14083 return loc;
14084
14085 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14086 }
14087
14088 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14089 enum class extract_bp_kind
14090 {
14091 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14092 bp,
14093
14094 /* Extracting a location number. */
14095 loc,
14096 };
14097
14098 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14099 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14100 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14101 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14102 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14103
14104 static int
14105 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
14106 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
14107 {
14108 const char *end = start;
14109 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
14110 if (num < 0)
14111 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14112 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14113 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14114 int (end - start), start);
14115 if (num == 0)
14116 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14117 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14118 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14119 int (end - start), start);
14120
14121 if (end_out != NULL)
14122 *end_out = end;
14123 return num;
14124 }
14125
14126 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14127 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14128 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14129 are always positive integers. */
14130
14131 static std::pair<int, int>
14132 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
14133 const std::string &arg,
14134 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
14135 {
14136 std::pair<int, int> range;
14137 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14138 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14139 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14140 {
14141 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14142 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14143 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14144 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14145 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14146 bp_loc);
14147
14148 const char *end;
14149 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14150 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14151 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14152 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14153
14154 if (range.first > range.second)
14155 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14156 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14157 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14158 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14159 }
14160 else
14161 {
14162 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14163 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14164 range.second = range.first;
14165 }
14166 return range;
14167 }
14168
14169 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14170 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14171 BP_LOC_RANGE.
14172
14173 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14174
14175 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14176 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14177 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14178 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14179 location number range.
14180 */
14181
14182 static void
14183 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14184 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14185 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14186 {
14187 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14188
14189 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14190 {
14191 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14192
14193 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14194 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14195
14196 bp_num_range.first
14197 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14198 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14199
14200 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14201 arg, dot + 1);
14202 }
14203 else
14204 {
14205 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14206
14207 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14208 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14209 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14210 }
14211 }
14212
14213 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14214 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14215
14216 static void
14217 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14218 {
14219 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14220 if (loc != NULL)
14221 {
14222 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14223 {
14224 loc->enabled = enable;
14225 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14226 }
14227 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14228 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14229 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14230 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14231 }
14232 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14233 }
14234
14235 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14236 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14237 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14238 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14239 location. */
14240
14241 static void
14242 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14243 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14244 bool enable)
14245 {
14246 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14247 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14248 }
14249
14250 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14251 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14252 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14253
14254 void
14255 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14256 {
14257 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14258 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14259 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14260 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14261 return;
14262
14263 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14264
14265 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14266 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14267
14268 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14269 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14270 {
14271 struct bp_location *location;
14272
14273 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14274 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14275 }
14276
14277 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14278
14279 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14280 }
14281
14282 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14283 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14284 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14285 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14286
14287 static void
14288 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14289 {
14290 if (args == 0)
14291 {
14292 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14293
14294 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14295 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14296 {
14297 if (enable)
14298 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14299 else
14300 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14301 }
14302 }
14303 else
14304 {
14305 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14306
14307 while (!num.empty ())
14308 {
14309 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14310
14311 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14312
14313 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14314 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14315 {
14316 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14317 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14318 enable
14319 ? enable_breakpoint
14320 : disable_breakpoint);
14321 }
14322 else
14323 {
14324 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14325 'x.y-z'. */
14326 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14327 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14328 }
14329 num = extract_arg (&args);
14330 }
14331 }
14332 }
14333
14334 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14335 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14336 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14337 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14338
14339 static void
14340 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14341 {
14342 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14343 }
14344
14345 static void
14346 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14347 int count)
14348 {
14349 int target_resources_ok;
14350
14351 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14352 {
14353 int i;
14354 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14355 target_resources_ok =
14356 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14357 i + 1, 0);
14358 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14359 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14360 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14361 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14362 }
14363
14364 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14365 {
14366 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14367 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14368
14369 TRY
14370 {
14371 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14372
14373 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14374 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14375 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14376 }
14377 CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
14378 {
14379 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14380 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14381 bpt->number);
14382 return;
14383 }
14384 END_CATCH
14385 }
14386
14387 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14388
14389 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14390 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14391
14392 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14393 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14394 {
14395 struct bp_location *location;
14396
14397 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14398 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14399 }
14400
14401 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14402 bpt->enable_count = count;
14403 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14404
14405 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14406 }
14407
14408
14409 void
14410 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14411 {
14412 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14413 }
14414
14415 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14416 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14417 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14418 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14419
14420 static void
14421 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14422 {
14423 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14424 }
14425
14426 static void
14427 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14428 {
14429 map_breakpoint_numbers
14430 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14431 {
14432 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14433 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14434 {
14435 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14436 });
14437 });
14438 }
14439
14440 static void
14441 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14442 {
14443 int count;
14444
14445 if (args == NULL)
14446 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14447
14448 count = get_number (&args);
14449
14450 map_breakpoint_numbers
14451 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14452 {
14453 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14454 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14455 {
14456 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14457 });
14458 });
14459 }
14460
14461 static void
14462 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14463 {
14464 map_breakpoint_numbers
14465 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14466 {
14467 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14468 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14469 {
14470 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14471 });
14472 });
14473 }
14474 \f
14475 static void
14476 set_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14477 {
14478 }
14479
14480 static void
14481 show_breakpoint_cmd (const char *args, int from_tty)
14482 {
14483 }
14484
14485 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14486 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14487 GDB itself. */
14488
14489 static void
14490 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14491 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14492 const bfd_byte *data)
14493 {
14494 struct breakpoint *bp;
14495
14496 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
14497 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14498 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14499 {
14500 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14501
14502 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
14503 {
14504 struct bp_location *loc;
14505
14506 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14507 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14508 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14509 && addr + len > loc->address)
14510 {
14511 wp->val = NULL;
14512 wp->val_valid = 0;
14513 }
14514 }
14515 }
14516 }
14517
14518 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14519
14520 void
14521 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14522 const address_space *aspace,
14523 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14524 {
14525 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14526 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14527 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14528
14529 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14530 {
14531 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14532 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14533 }
14534
14535 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14536 sal.pc = pc;
14537 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14538 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14539 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14540
14541 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14542 }
14543
14544 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14545
14546 int
14547 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14548 {
14549 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14550 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14551
14552 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14553
14554 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14555 {
14556 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14557 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14558
14559 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14560 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14561
14562 return 1;
14563 }
14564 else
14565 return 0;
14566 }
14567
14568 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14569
14570 int
14571 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14572 const address_space *aspace,
14573 CORE_ADDR pc)
14574 {
14575 struct bp_location *loc;
14576
14577 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
14578 if (loc->inserted
14579 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14580 return 1;
14581
14582 return 0;
14583 }
14584
14585 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14586 PC. */
14587
14588 int
14589 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14590 CORE_ADDR pc)
14591 {
14592 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14593
14594 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14595 {
14596 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14597 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14598 return 1;
14599 }
14600 return 0;
14601 }
14602
14603 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14604
14605 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14606 static void
14607 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14608 {
14609 tracepoint_count = num;
14610 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14611 }
14612
14613 static void
14614 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14615 {
14616 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14617
14618 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14619 current_language);
14620 if (location != NULL
14621 && event_location_type (location.get ()) == PROBE_LOCATION)
14622 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
14623 else
14624 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14625
14626 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14627 location.get (),
14628 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14629 0 /* tempflag */,
14630 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14631 0 /* Ignore count */,
14632 pending_break_support,
14633 ops,
14634 from_tty,
14635 1 /* enabled */,
14636 0 /* internal */, 0);
14637 }
14638
14639 static void
14640 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14641 {
14642 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14643 current_language);
14644 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14645 location.get (),
14646 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14647 0 /* tempflag */,
14648 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14649 0 /* Ignore count */,
14650 pending_break_support,
14651 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14652 from_tty,
14653 1 /* enabled */,
14654 0 /* internal */, 0);
14655 }
14656
14657 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14658
14659 static void
14660 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14661 {
14662 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14663 event_location_up location;
14664
14665 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14666 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14667 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14668 {
14669 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14670 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14671 }
14672 else
14673 {
14674 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14675 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14676 }
14677
14678 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14679 location.get (),
14680 NULL, 0, arg, 1 /* parse arg */,
14681 0 /* tempflag */,
14682 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14683 0 /* Ignore count */,
14684 pending_break_support,
14685 ops,
14686 from_tty,
14687 1 /* enabled */,
14688 0 /* internal */, 0);
14689 }
14690
14691 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14692 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14693
14694 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14695 static int next_cmd;
14696
14697 static char *
14698 read_uploaded_action (void)
14699 {
14700 char *rslt = nullptr;
14701
14702 if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
14703 {
14704 rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd];
14705 next_cmd++;
14706 }
14707
14708 return rslt;
14709 }
14710
14711 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14712 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14713 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14714 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14715 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14716
14717 struct tracepoint *
14718 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14719 {
14720 const char *addr_str;
14721 char small_buf[100];
14722 struct tracepoint *tp;
14723
14724 if (utp->at_string)
14725 addr_str = utp->at_string;
14726 else
14727 {
14728 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14729 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14730 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14731 user. */
14732 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14733 "source location, using raw address"),
14734 utp->number);
14735 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14736 addr_str = small_buf;
14737 }
14738
14739 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14740 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14741 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14742 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14743 utp->number);
14744
14745 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14746 current_language);
14747 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14748 location.get (),
14749 utp->cond_string, -1, addr_str,
14750 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14751 0 /* tempflag */,
14752 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14753 0 /* Ignore count */,
14754 pending_break_support,
14755 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14756 0 /* from_tty */,
14757 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14758 0 /* internal */,
14759 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14760 return NULL;
14761
14762 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14763 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14764 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14765
14766 if (utp->pass > 0)
14767 {
14768 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14769 tp->number);
14770
14771 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14772 }
14773
14774 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14775 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14776 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14777 function. */
14778 if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
14779 {
14780 counted_command_line cmd_list;
14781
14782 this_utp = utp;
14783 next_cmd = 0;
14784
14785 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
14786
14787 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14788 }
14789 else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
14790 || !utp->step_actions.empty ())
14791 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14792 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14793 utp->number);
14794
14795 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14796 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14797 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14798
14799 return tp;
14800 }
14801
14802 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14803 omitted. */
14804
14805 static void
14806 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14807 {
14808 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14809 int num_printed;
14810
14811 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
14812
14813 if (num_printed == 0)
14814 {
14815 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14816 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14817 else
14818 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14819 }
14820
14821 default_collect_info ();
14822 }
14823
14824 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14825 Not supported by all targets. */
14826 static void
14827 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14828 {
14829 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14830 }
14831
14832 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14833 Not supported by all targets. */
14834 static void
14835 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14836 {
14837 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14838 }
14839
14840 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14841 static void
14842 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14843 {
14844 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14845
14846 dont_repeat ();
14847
14848 if (arg == 0)
14849 {
14850 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14851
14852 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14853 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14854 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14855 argument. */
14856 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14857 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14858 {
14859 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14860 break;
14861 }
14862
14863 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14864 if (!from_tty
14865 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14866 {
14867 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14868 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14869 delete_breakpoint (b);
14870 }
14871 }
14872 else
14873 map_breakpoint_numbers
14874 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14875 {
14876 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, delete_breakpoint);
14877 });
14878 }
14879
14880 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14881
14882 static void
14883 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14884 {
14885 tp->pass_count = count;
14886 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
14887 if (from_tty)
14888 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14889 tp->number, count);
14890 }
14891
14892 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14893
14894 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14895 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14896 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14897
14898 static void
14899 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14900 {
14901 struct tracepoint *t1;
14902 ULONGEST count;
14903
14904 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14905 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14906 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14907
14908 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14909
14910 args = skip_spaces (args);
14911 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14912 {
14913 struct breakpoint *b;
14914
14915 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14916 if (*args)
14917 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14918
14919 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14920 {
14921 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14922 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14923 }
14924 }
14925 else if (*args == '\0')
14926 {
14927 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14928 if (t1)
14929 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14930 }
14931 else
14932 {
14933 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14934 while (!parser.finished ())
14935 {
14936 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
14937 if (t1)
14938 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14939 }
14940 }
14941 }
14942
14943 struct tracepoint *
14944 get_tracepoint (int num)
14945 {
14946 struct breakpoint *t;
14947
14948 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
14949 if (t->number == num)
14950 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14951
14952 return NULL;
14953 }
14954
14955 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14956 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14957 reconnecting). */
14958
14959 struct tracepoint *
14960 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
14961 {
14962 struct breakpoint *b;
14963
14964 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
14965 {
14966 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14967
14968 if (t->number_on_target == num)
14969 return t;
14970 }
14971
14972 return NULL;
14973 }
14974
14975 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14976 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14977 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14978 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14979
14980 struct tracepoint *
14981 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
14982 number_or_range_parser *parser)
14983 {
14984 struct breakpoint *t;
14985 int tpnum;
14986 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
14987
14988 if (parser != NULL)
14989 {
14990 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
14991 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
14992 }
14993 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
14994 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
14995 else
14996 tpnum = get_number (arg);
14997
14998 if (tpnum <= 0)
14999 {
15000 if (instring && *instring)
15001 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15002 instring);
15003 else
15004 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
15005 return NULL;
15006 }
15007
15008 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15009 if (t->number == tpnum)
15010 {
15011 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15012 }
15013
15014 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15015 return NULL;
15016 }
15017
15018 void
15019 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15020 {
15021 if (b->thread != -1)
15022 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15023
15024 if (b->task != 0)
15025 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15026
15027 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15028 }
15029
15030 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15031 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15032 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15033 non-zero. */
15034
15035 static void
15036 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
15037 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15038 {
15039 struct breakpoint *tp;
15040 int any = 0;
15041 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15042
15043 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15044 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15045
15046 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15047 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15048 {
15049 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15050 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15051 continue;
15052
15053 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15054 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15055 continue;
15056
15057 any = 1;
15058
15059 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15060 {
15061 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15062
15063 /* We can stop searching. */
15064 break;
15065 }
15066 }
15067
15068 if (!any)
15069 {
15070 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15071 return;
15072 }
15073
15074 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
15075
15076 stdio_file fp;
15077
15078 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
15079 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15080 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
15081
15082 if (extra_trace_bits)
15083 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
15084
15085 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15086 {
15087 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15088 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15089 continue;
15090
15091 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15092 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15093 continue;
15094
15095 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
15096
15097 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15098 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15099 instead. */
15100
15101 if (tp->cond_string)
15102 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15103
15104 if (tp->ignore_count)
15105 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15106
15107 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15108 {
15109 fp.puts (" commands\n");
15110
15111 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
15112 TRY
15113 {
15114 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
15115 }
15116 CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15117 {
15118 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15119 throw_exception (ex);
15120 }
15121 END_CATCH
15122
15123 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15124 fp.puts (" end\n");
15125 }
15126
15127 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15128 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15129
15130 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15131 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15132 special, and not user visible. */
15133 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15134 {
15135 struct bp_location *loc;
15136 int n = 1;
15137
15138 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15139 if (!loc->enabled)
15140 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15141 }
15142 }
15143
15144 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15145 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15146
15147 if (from_tty)
15148 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15149 }
15150
15151 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15152
15153 static void
15154 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15155 {
15156 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15157 }
15158
15159 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15160
15161 static void
15162 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15163 {
15164 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15165 }
15166
15167 /* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15168
15169 VEC(breakpoint_p) *
15170 all_tracepoints (void)
15171 {
15172 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
15173 struct breakpoint *tp;
15174
15175 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15176 {
15177 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
15178 }
15179
15180 return tp_vec;
15181 }
15182
15183 \f
15184 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15185 locations used by several commands. */
15186
15187 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15188 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15189 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15190 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15191 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15192 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15193 \n\
15194 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15195 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15196 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15197 \n\
15198 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15199 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15200 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15201 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15202 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15203 \n\
15204 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15205 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15206 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15207 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15208 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15209 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead.\n"
15210
15211 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15212 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15213 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15214 command. */
15215
15216 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15217 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15218 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15219 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15220 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15221 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15222 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15223 below.\n\
15224 \n\
15225 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15226 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15227 \n\
15228 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15229 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15230 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15231 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15232 conditions are different.\n\
15233 \n\
15234 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15235
15236 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15237 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15238
15239 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15240 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15241
15242 void
15243 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15244 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15245 completer_ftype *completer,
15246 void *user_data_catch,
15247 void *user_data_tcatch)
15248 {
15249 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15250
15251 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15252 &catch_cmdlist);
15253 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15254 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15255 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15256
15257 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15258 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15259 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15260 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15261 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15262 }
15263
15264 static void
15265 save_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
15266 {
15267 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15268 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15269 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15270 }
15271
15272 struct breakpoint *
15273 iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15274 void *data)
15275 {
15276 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15277
15278 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15279 {
15280 if ((*callback) (b, data))
15281 return b;
15282 }
15283
15284 return NULL;
15285 }
15286
15287 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15288 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15289
15290 static int
15291 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15292 {
15293 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15294 non-inline function. */
15295 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15296 return 1;
15297
15298 return 0;
15299 }
15300
15301 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15302 have been inlined. */
15303
15304 int
15305 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15306 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15307 {
15308 struct breakpoint *b;
15309 struct bp_location *bl;
15310
15311 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
15312 {
15313 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15314 continue;
15315
15316 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
15317 {
15318 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15319 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15320 return 1;
15321 }
15322 }
15323
15324 return 0;
15325 }
15326
15327 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15328
15329 void
15330 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15331 {
15332 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
15333
15334 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
15335 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15336 loc->symtab = NULL;
15337 }
15338
15339 void
15340 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15341 {
15342 static int initialized = 0;
15343
15344 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15345
15346 if (initialized)
15347 return;
15348 initialized = 1;
15349
15350 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15351 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15352 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15353 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15354 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15355 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15356 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15357 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15358 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15359 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15360 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15361 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15362
15363 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15364 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15365 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15366 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15367 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15368 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15369 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15370 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15371
15372 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15373 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15374 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15375 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15376 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15377 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15378 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15379 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15380 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15381 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15382
15383 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15384 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15385 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15386 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15387 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15388 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15389 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15390
15391 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15392 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15393 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15394 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15395 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15396 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15397 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15398
15399 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15400 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15401 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15402 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15403 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15404 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15405 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15406
15407 /* Watchpoints. */
15408 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15409 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15410 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15411 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15412 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15413 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15414 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15415 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15416 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15417 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15418 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15419 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15420 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15421
15422 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15423 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15424 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15425 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15426 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15427 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15428 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15429 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15430 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15431 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15432 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15433
15434 /* Tracepoints. */
15435 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15436 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15437 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15438 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15439 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15440 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15441 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15442 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15443 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15444 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15445
15446 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15447 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15448 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15449 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15450 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15451
15452 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15453 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15454 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15455 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15456 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15457 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15458
15459 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15460 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15461 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15462 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15463 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15464 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15465 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15466 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15467 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15468 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15469
15470 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15471 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15472 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15473 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15474 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15475 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15476 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15477 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15478 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15479 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15480
15481 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15482 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15483 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15484 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15485 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15486 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15487 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15488 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15489 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15490 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15491
15492 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15493 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15494 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15495 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15496 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15497 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15498 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15499 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15500 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15501 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15502 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15503
15504 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15505 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15506 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15507 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15508 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15509 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15510 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15511 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15512 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15513 }
15514
15515 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15516
15517 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15518
15519 void
15520 _initialize_breakpoint (void)
15521 {
15522 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15523
15524 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15525
15526 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
15527 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
15528 gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
15529
15530 breakpoint_objfile_key
15531 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_objfile_data);
15532
15533 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15534 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15535 before a breakpoint is set. */
15536 breakpoint_count = 0;
15537
15538 tracepoint_count = 0;
15539
15540 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15541 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15542 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15543
15544 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
15545 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15546 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15547 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15548 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
15549 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15550 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15551 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15552 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15553 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15554
15555 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
15556 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15557 Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
15558 expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
15559 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
15560
15561 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15562 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15563 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15564 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15565 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15566 \n"
15567 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15568 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15569
15570 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15571 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15572 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15573 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15574 \n"
15575 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15576 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15577
15578 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15579 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15580 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15581 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15582 \n"
15583 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15584 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15585
15586 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15587 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15588 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15589 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15590 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15591 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15592 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15593
15594 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15595
15596 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15597 Enable some breakpoints.\n\
15598 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15599 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15600 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
15601 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
15602
15603 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15604 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15605 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15606 &enablebreaklist);
15607
15608 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15609 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15610 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15611 &enablebreaklist);
15612
15613 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15614 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15615 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15616 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15617 &enablebreaklist);
15618
15619 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15620 Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15621 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15622 &enablelist);
15623
15624 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15625 Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
15626 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15627 &enablelist);
15628
15629 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15630 Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
15631 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15632 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15633 &enablelist);
15634
15635 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15636 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15637 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15638 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15639 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15640 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
15641 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15642 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
15643
15644 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
15645 Disable some breakpoints.\n\
15646 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15647 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15648 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15649 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15650 &disablelist);
15651
15652 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15653 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15654 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15655 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15656 \n\
15657 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
15658 The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
15659 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
15660 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15661 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
15662
15663 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
15664 Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15665 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15666 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15667 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15668 &deletelist);
15669
15670 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15671 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15672 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15673 \n\
15674 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15675 is executing in.\n"
15676 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15677 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15678 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
15679
15680 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15681 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15682 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15683 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15684
15685 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
15686 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
15687 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
15688 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
15689
15690 if (dbx_commands)
15691 {
15692 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15693 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15694 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
15695 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15696 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15697 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15698 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15699 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15700 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15701 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15702 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15703 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15704 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15705 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15706 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15707 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15708 \n\
15709 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15710 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15711 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15712 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15713 breakpoint set."));
15714 }
15715
15716 add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15717 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15718 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15719 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15720 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15721 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15722 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15723 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15724 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15725 \n\
15726 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15727 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15728 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15729 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15730 breakpoint set."));
15731
15732 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
15733
15734 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15735 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15736 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15737 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15738 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15739 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15740 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15741 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15742 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15743 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15744 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15745 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15746 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15747 \n\
15748 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15749 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15750 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15751 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15752 breakpoint set."),
15753 &maintenanceinfolist);
15754
15755 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
15756 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15757 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
15758 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15759
15760 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
15761 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15762 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
15763 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15764
15765 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15766 catch_fork_command_1,
15767 NULL,
15768 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15769 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15770 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15771 catch_fork_command_1,
15772 NULL,
15773 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15774 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15775 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15776 catch_exec_command_1,
15777 NULL,
15778 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15779 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15780 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15781 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15782 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15783 catch_load_command_1,
15784 NULL,
15785 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15786 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15787 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15788 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15789 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15790 catch_unload_command_1,
15791 NULL,
15792 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15793 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15794
15795 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
15796 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15797 Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15798 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15799 an expression changes.\n\
15800 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15801 the memory to which it refers."));
15802 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15803
15804 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
15805 Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15806 Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15807 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15808 an expression is read.\n\
15809 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15810 the memory to which it refers."));
15811 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15812
15813 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
15814 Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
15815 Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15816 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15817 an expression is either read or written.\n\
15818 If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
15819 the memory to which it refers."));
15820 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
15821
15822 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15823 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15824
15825 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15826 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15827 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15828 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15829 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15830 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15831 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15832 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15833 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15834 hardware.)"),
15835 NULL,
15836 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15837 &setlist, &showlist);
15838
15839 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15840
15841 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15842
15843 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15844 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15845 \n"
15846 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15847 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15848 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15849
15850 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
15851 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15852 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15853 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
15854
15855 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15856 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15857 \n"
15858 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15859 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15860 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15861
15862 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15863 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15864 \n\
15865 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15866 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15867 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15868 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15869 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15870 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15871 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15872 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15873 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15874 \n\
15875 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15876 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\
15877 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15878 conditions are different.\n\
15879 \n\
15880 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15881 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15882 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15883
15884 add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15885 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15886 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15887 last tracepoint set."));
15888
15889 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
15890
15891 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15892 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15893 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15894 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15895 &deletelist);
15896 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15897
15898 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15899 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15900 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15901 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15902 &disablelist);
15903 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15904
15905 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15906 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15907 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15908 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15909 &enablelist);
15910 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15911
15912 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15913 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15914 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15915 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15916 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15917
15918 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
15919 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15920 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
15921 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15922
15923 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15924 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15925 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15926 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15927 session to restore them."),
15928 &save_cmdlist);
15929 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15930
15931 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15932 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15933 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15934 &save_cmdlist);
15935 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15936
15937 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
15938 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
15939
15940 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15941 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15942 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15943 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15944 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
15945 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
15946 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
15947 Breakpoint specific settings\n\
15948 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15949 pending breakpoint behavior"),
15950 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
15951 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
15952
15953 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
15954 &pending_break_support, _("\
15955 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15956 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15957 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15958 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15959 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15960 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15961 NULL,
15962 show_pending_break_support,
15963 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15964 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15965
15966 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
15967
15968 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
15969 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
15970 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15971 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15972 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15973 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15974 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15975 NULL,
15976 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
15977 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15978 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15979
15980 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
15981 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
15982 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15983 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15984 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15985 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15986 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15987 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15988 when execution stops."),
15989 NULL,
15990 &show_always_inserted_mode,
15991 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15992 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15993
15994 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
15995 condition_evaluation_enums,
15996 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
15997 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15998 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15999 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16000 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16001 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16002 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16003 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16004 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16005 be set to \"gdb\""),
16006 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16007 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16008 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16009 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16010
16011 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16012 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16013 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16014 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16015 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16016 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16017 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16018 or the start of the range\n\
16019 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16020 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16021 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16022 \n\
16023 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16024 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16025 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16026
16027 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16028 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16029 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16030 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16031 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16032 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16033
16034 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16035 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16036 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16037 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16038 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16039 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16040 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16041 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16042 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16043 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16044 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16045 &setlist, &showlist);
16046
16047 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16048 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16049 &dprintf_function, _("\
16050 Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16051 Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16052 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16053 &setlist, &showlist);
16054
16055 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16056 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16057 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16058 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16059 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16060 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16061 &setlist, &showlist);
16062
16063 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16064 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16065 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16066 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16067 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16068 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16069 NULL,
16070 NULL,
16071 &setlist, &showlist);
16072
16073 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16074 agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16075 (target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16076
16077 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16078
16079 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16080 gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16081 }
This page took 0.371659 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.